1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.90"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
448 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
452 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
453 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
454 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
455 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
456 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
460 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
461 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
462 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
463 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
464 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
467 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
468 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
469 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
473 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
474 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
475 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
478 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
479 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
480 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
481 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
484 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
485 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
486 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
487 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
488 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
491 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
493 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
511 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
513 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
514 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
515 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
517 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
518 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
519 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
520 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
523 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
525 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
526 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
527 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
529 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
530 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
531 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
532 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
533 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
534 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
535 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
536 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
537 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
538 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
539 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
541 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
542 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
543 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
544 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
546 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
547 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
548 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
550 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
552 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
555 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
556 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
557 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
559 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
560 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
561 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
562 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
564 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
565 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
566 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
569 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
570 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
573 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
575 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
576 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
577 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
578 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
579 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
580 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
581 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
583 .cindex "domainless addresses"
584 .cindex "address" "without domain"
585 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
586 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
587 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
588 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
591 .cindex "transport" "external"
592 .cindex "external transports"
593 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
594 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
595 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
596 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
597 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
598 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
600 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
601 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
602 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
605 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
606 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
607 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
608 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
609 a number of common scanners are provided.
613 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
614 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
615 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
616 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
617 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
618 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
621 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
622 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
623 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
624 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
625 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
626 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
627 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
628 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
629 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
630 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
631 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
632 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
634 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
635 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
636 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
637 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
641 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
642 .cindex "terminology definitions"
643 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
644 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
645 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
646 below) by a blank line.
648 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
649 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
650 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
651 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
652 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
653 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
654 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
655 rise to further bounce messages.
657 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
658 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
659 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
662 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
663 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
664 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
667 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
668 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
669 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
671 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
672 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
673 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
674 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
675 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
676 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
677 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
678 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
680 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
681 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
682 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
683 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
684 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
685 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
688 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
689 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
690 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
691 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
692 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
694 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
695 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
696 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
697 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
698 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
699 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
701 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
702 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
705 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
706 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
707 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
708 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
709 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
711 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
712 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
713 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
714 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
715 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
717 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
718 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
719 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
720 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
721 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
722 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
732 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
733 .cindex "incorporated code"
734 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
737 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
740 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
741 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
742 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
743 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
744 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
745 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
747 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
748 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
749 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
750 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
751 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
752 following statements:
755 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
757 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
758 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
759 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
761 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
762 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
763 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
764 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
765 restrictions applied to it).
768 .cindex "SPA authentication"
769 .cindex "Samba project"
770 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
771 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
772 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
773 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
777 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
778 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
779 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
780 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
781 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
782 conditions expressed therein.
785 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
787 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
788 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
792 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
793 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
795 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
796 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
797 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
800 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
801 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
802 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
803 details, please contact
805 Office of Technology Transfer
806 Carnegie Mellon University
808 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
809 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
810 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
813 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
816 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
817 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
819 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
820 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
821 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
822 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
823 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
824 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
825 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
830 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
833 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
834 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
835 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
836 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
839 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
840 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
844 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
845 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
846 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
847 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
848 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
849 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
850 software without specific, written prior permission.
852 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
853 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
854 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
855 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
856 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
857 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
862 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
863 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
864 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
865 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
866 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
870 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
871 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
872 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
879 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
880 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
882 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
883 "Receiving and delivering mail"
886 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
887 .cindex "design philosophy"
888 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
889 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
890 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
891 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
892 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
893 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
896 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
897 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
898 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
899 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
900 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
901 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
902 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
905 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
906 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
907 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
908 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
909 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
910 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
911 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
912 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
913 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
916 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
917 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
919 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
920 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
921 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
922 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
924 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
925 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
926 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
927 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
928 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
930 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
931 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
932 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
934 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
935 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
936 runs at the start of every delivery process.
941 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
942 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
943 .cindex "Sieve filter"
944 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
945 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
946 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
947 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
948 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
949 of filtering are available:
952 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
955 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
956 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
959 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
963 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
964 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
965 .cindex "format" "of message id"
966 .cindex "id of message"
971 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
972 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
973 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
974 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
975 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
976 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
977 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
978 not always case-sensitive.
980 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
981 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
982 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
983 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
984 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
985 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
989 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
990 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
991 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
992 way of representing the date and time of day).
994 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
995 received the message.
997 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
999 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1000 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1001 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1002 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1003 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1005 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1006 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1007 (1/100) of a second.
1011 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1012 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1013 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1014 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1015 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1018 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1019 .cindex "receiving mail"
1020 .cindex "message" "reception"
1021 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1022 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1023 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1024 there are several possibilities:
1027 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1028 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1029 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1031 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1032 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1033 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1034 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1035 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1036 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1039 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1040 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1041 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1042 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1044 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1045 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1046 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1047 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1051 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1052 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1053 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1054 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1055 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1056 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1057 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1058 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1059 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1060 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1061 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1062 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1063 users to change sender addresses.
1065 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1066 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1067 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1068 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1069 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1070 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1071 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1073 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1074 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1075 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1076 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1077 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1078 message is received.
1084 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1085 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1086 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1087 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1088 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1089 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1090 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1091 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1093 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1094 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1095 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1096 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1097 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1098 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1099 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1100 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1101 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1102 affect file system performance.
1104 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1105 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1106 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1107 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1108 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1110 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1111 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1112 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1113 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1114 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1115 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1116 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1117 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1118 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1119 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1120 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1121 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1125 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1126 .cindex "message" "life of"
1127 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1128 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1129 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1130 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1131 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1132 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1133 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1135 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1136 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1137 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1138 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1139 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1142 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1143 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1144 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1145 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1146 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1148 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1149 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1150 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1151 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1152 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1153 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1154 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1155 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1156 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1157 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1160 .cindex "journal file"
1161 .cindex "file" "journal"
1162 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1163 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1164 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1165 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1166 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1167 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1168 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1169 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1171 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1172 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1173 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1174 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1175 deliveries caused by crashes.
1179 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1180 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1181 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1182 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1183 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1184 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1185 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1186 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1187 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1189 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1190 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1191 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1192 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1193 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1194 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1195 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1196 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1197 the driver's features in general.
1199 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1200 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1201 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1202 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1205 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1206 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1207 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1208 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1209 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1210 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1212 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1213 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1214 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1215 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1216 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1217 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1219 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1220 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1221 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1224 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1225 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1226 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1227 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1228 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1229 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1230 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1231 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1232 configured to fail the address.
1234 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1235 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1236 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1237 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1238 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1239 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1241 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1242 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1243 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1244 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1245 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1246 the address is bounced.
1250 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1251 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1252 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1253 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1254 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1255 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1256 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1257 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1259 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1260 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1261 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1262 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1263 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1264 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1265 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1266 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1271 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1272 .cindex "router" "running details"
1273 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1274 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1275 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1276 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1277 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1278 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1282 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1283 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1284 original address ceases,
1285 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1286 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1287 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1288 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1289 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1292 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1293 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1294 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1295 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1296 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1298 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1299 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1300 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1301 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1302 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1304 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1305 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1306 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1307 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1308 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1310 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1311 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1312 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1314 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1315 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1316 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1317 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1319 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1320 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1323 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1324 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1325 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1326 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1327 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1329 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1330 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1331 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1332 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1333 facility for this purpose.
1336 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1337 .cindex "case of local parts"
1338 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1339 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1340 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1341 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1342 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1343 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1344 routed addresses are shown.
1348 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1349 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1350 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1351 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1352 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1353 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1356 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1357 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1358 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1359 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1360 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1361 of any other conditions.
1363 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1364 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1365 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1367 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1368 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1369 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1370 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1371 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1373 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1374 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1375 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1376 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1377 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1379 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1380 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1381 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1383 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1384 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1386 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1387 of domains that it defines.
1389 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1390 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1391 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1392 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1393 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1394 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1395 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1396 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1397 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1398 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1400 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1403 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1404 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1405 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1406 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1407 remaining preconditions.
1409 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1410 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1411 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1412 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1413 could lead to confusion.
1415 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1416 set of addresses that it defines.
1418 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1419 specified files is tested.
1421 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1422 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1423 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1424 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1428 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1429 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1430 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1431 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1432 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1433 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1434 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1438 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1439 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1440 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1443 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1444 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1445 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1446 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1447 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1449 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1450 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1452 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1453 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1454 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1455 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1456 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1457 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1460 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1461 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1462 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1463 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1464 processed entirely independently of each other.
1466 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1467 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1468 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1469 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1470 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1471 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1472 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1473 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1474 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1476 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1477 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1478 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1479 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1480 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1481 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1482 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1483 addresses to the same domain.
1485 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1486 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1487 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1488 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1489 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1490 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1491 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1492 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1494 .cindex "queue runner"
1495 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1496 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1497 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1498 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1499 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1500 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1501 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1502 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1503 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1505 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1506 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1507 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1508 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1509 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1510 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1512 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1513 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1514 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1515 messages to other addresses.
1517 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1518 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1519 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1522 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1523 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1524 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1530 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1531 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1532 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1533 .cindex "queue runner"
1534 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1535 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1536 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1537 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1538 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1539 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1540 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1541 passed its retry time.
1542 You can run several queue runners at once.
1544 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1545 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1546 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1547 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1548 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1553 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1554 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1555 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1556 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1557 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1558 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1559 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1560 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1561 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1564 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1565 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1566 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1568 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1569 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1570 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1571 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1572 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1577 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1578 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1579 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1580 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1581 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1582 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1583 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1584 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1585 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1586 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1587 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1589 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1590 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1591 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1594 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1595 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1596 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1597 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1598 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1599 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1600 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1605 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1606 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1607 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1608 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1609 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1610 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1611 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1612 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1621 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1622 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1624 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1625 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1626 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1627 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1630 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1631 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1633 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1634 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1635 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1636 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1640 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1641 following subdirectories are created:
1644 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1645 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1646 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1647 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1648 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1649 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1650 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1653 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1654 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1655 that may be useful to some sites.
1658 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1659 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1660 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1661 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1662 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1663 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1665 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1666 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1667 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1668 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1669 overridden if necessary.
1670 .cindex compiler requirements
1671 .cindex compiler version
1672 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1675 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1676 .cindex "PCRE library"
1677 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1678 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1679 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1680 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1681 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1682 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1683 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1684 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1685 If your operating system has no
1686 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1687 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1688 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1690 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1691 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1692 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1693 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1694 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1695 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1696 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1698 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1699 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1700 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1701 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1702 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1703 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1704 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1705 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1707 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1708 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1709 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1710 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1711 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1712 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1713 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1714 Berkeley DB library.
1716 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1717 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1721 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1722 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1724 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1725 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1726 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1727 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1728 file name is used unmodified.
1730 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1731 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1732 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1733 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1735 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1736 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1737 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1739 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1740 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1741 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1742 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1743 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1744 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1746 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1747 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1748 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1749 operates on a single file.
1753 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1754 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1755 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1756 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1757 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1761 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1762 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1764 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1765 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1766 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1767 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1768 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1769 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1771 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1772 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1773 in one of these lines:
1778 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1779 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1780 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1781 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1784 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1785 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1787 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1788 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1792 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1793 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1794 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1795 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1796 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1797 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1798 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1799 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1800 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1801 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1802 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1803 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1805 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1806 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1807 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1808 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1809 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1810 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1812 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1813 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1814 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1815 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1816 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1817 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1820 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1821 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1822 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1823 facilities, you need to set
1825 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1827 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1828 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1831 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1832 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1833 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1834 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1835 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1836 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1837 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1839 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1840 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1841 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1842 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1843 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1848 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1849 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1851 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1852 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1853 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1854 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1855 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1856 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1857 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1859 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1860 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1861 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1862 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1863 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1867 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1871 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1872 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1873 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1874 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1875 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1876 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1877 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1878 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1879 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1880 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1883 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1884 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1887 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1890 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1892 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1893 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1896 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1897 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1899 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1900 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1903 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1905 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1906 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1910 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1912 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1913 library and include files. For example:
1917 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1920 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1921 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1925 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1928 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1929 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1930 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1935 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1937 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1938 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1939 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1940 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1941 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1942 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1943 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1944 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1945 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1946 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1947 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1948 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1951 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1952 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1953 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1955 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1956 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1958 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1960 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1961 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1962 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1963 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1964 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1965 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1969 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1970 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1971 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1972 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1973 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1974 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1977 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1978 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1979 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1980 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1981 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1983 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1988 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1989 .cindex "lookup modules"
1990 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1991 .cindex ".so building"
1992 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1993 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1995 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1996 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1998 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2000 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2001 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2002 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2003 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2004 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2005 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2007 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2008 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2009 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2018 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2019 .cindex "build directory"
2020 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2021 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2022 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2023 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2024 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2025 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2026 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2028 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2029 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2030 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2031 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2032 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2033 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2034 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2035 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2037 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2038 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2039 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2043 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2044 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2045 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2046 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2047 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2048 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2049 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2053 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2054 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2055 given in addition to the short output.
2059 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2060 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2061 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2062 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2063 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2064 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2065 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2068 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2069 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2071 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2072 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2073 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2074 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2076 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2077 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2078 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2079 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2080 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2081 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2082 and are often not needed.
2084 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2085 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2086 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2087 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2088 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2089 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2090 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2091 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2092 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2095 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2096 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2097 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2098 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2102 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2103 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2104 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2105 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2106 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2107 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2108 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2109 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2110 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2111 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2112 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2113 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2114 containing the lines
2119 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2120 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2122 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2123 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2124 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2127 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2128 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2129 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2130 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2131 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2132 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2133 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2134 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2135 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2136 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2142 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2143 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2144 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2145 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2146 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2147 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2148 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2149 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2152 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2153 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2154 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2155 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2156 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2157 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2158 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2159 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2160 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2161 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2162 syntax. For instance:
2165 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2167 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2168 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2169 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2172 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2173 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2174 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2178 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2179 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2181 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2182 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2183 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2184 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2185 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2186 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2189 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2190 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2192 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2193 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2199 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2200 definition of all three of these variables into your
2201 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2204 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2205 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2206 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2207 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2209 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2210 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2211 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2212 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2213 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2216 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2217 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2218 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2219 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2220 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2223 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2225 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2226 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2227 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2228 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2229 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2230 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2234 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2235 .cindex "building Eximon"
2236 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2237 where the files that are involved are
2239 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2240 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2241 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2242 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2243 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2244 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2246 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2247 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2248 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2250 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2251 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2252 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2256 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2257 .cindex "installing Exim"
2258 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2259 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2260 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2261 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2262 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2263 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2264 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2265 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2266 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2267 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2268 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2269 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2271 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2272 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2273 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2274 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2275 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2276 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2277 alternative files, no default is installed.
2279 .cindex "system aliases file"
2280 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2281 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2282 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2283 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2284 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2285 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2286 and outputs a comment to the user.
2288 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2289 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2290 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2291 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2292 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2294 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2295 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2296 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2297 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2298 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2301 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2302 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2305 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2307 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2308 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2309 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2310 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2311 but this usage is deprecated.
2313 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2314 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2315 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2316 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2317 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2318 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2320 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2321 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2322 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2323 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2324 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2325 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2326 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2329 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2330 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2333 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2335 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2336 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2337 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2338 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2341 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2344 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2347 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2348 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2350 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2354 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2356 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2358 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2359 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2360 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2362 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2367 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2368 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2369 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2370 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2371 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2374 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2375 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2376 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2380 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2381 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2382 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2383 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2384 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2390 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2391 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2392 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2393 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2394 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2398 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2399 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2400 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2401 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2402 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2405 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2407 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2409 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2411 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2412 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2413 user agent. For example:
2415 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2416 From: user@your.domain.example
2417 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2418 Subject: Testing Exim
2420 This is a test message.
2423 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2424 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2425 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2427 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2428 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2429 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2430 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2431 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2432 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2434 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2436 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2437 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2438 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2439 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2440 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2442 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2443 .cindex "lock files"
2444 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2445 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2446 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2447 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2448 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2449 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2450 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2451 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2452 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2453 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2454 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2455 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2457 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2458 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2459 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2460 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2461 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2464 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2465 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2466 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2467 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2471 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2472 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2473 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2474 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2475 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2476 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2477 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2478 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2479 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2480 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2481 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2482 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2483 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2485 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2486 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2487 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2488 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2489 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2490 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2493 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2494 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2495 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2496 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2498 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2499 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2500 favourite user agent.
2502 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2503 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2504 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2505 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2506 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2507 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2511 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2512 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2513 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2514 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2515 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2516 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2517 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2518 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2524 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2525 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2526 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2528 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2530 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2531 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2532 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2533 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2534 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2536 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2538 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2540 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2541 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2542 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2550 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2551 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2552 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2553 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2554 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2555 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2556 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2557 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2558 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2561 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2563 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2564 were present before any other options.
2565 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2567 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2568 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2569 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2572 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2573 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2574 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2578 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2579 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2580 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2583 .cindex "queue runner"
2584 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2585 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2586 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2588 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2589 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2590 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2592 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2593 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2594 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2595 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2598 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2599 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2600 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2601 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2602 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2603 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2606 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2607 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2608 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2609 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2610 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2611 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2613 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2614 .cindex "envelope sender"
2615 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2616 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2617 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2618 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2619 users to set envelope senders.
2621 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2622 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2623 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2624 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2625 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2626 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2627 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2629 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2630 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2631 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2632 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2633 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2634 that are available to trusted users.
2636 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2637 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2638 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2639 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2640 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2642 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2643 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2644 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2645 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2647 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2648 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2649 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2650 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2652 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2653 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2658 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2659 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2660 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2666 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2667 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2668 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2669 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2670 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2671 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2672 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2673 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2676 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2677 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2678 . creates a man page for the options.
2679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2682 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2689 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2690 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2691 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2692 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2695 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2696 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2697 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2700 .vitem &%--version%&
2701 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2702 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2709 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2712 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2714 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2715 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2716 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2717 clean; it ignores this option.
2722 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2723 .cindex "queue runner"
2724 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2725 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2726 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2728 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2729 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2730 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2731 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2733 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2734 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2735 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2736 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2738 When a listening daemon
2739 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2740 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2741 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2742 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2743 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2744 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2747 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2748 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2749 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2753 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2754 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2755 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2756 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2757 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2758 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2759 because these are reread each time they are used.
2763 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2764 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2768 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2769 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2770 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2771 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2772 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2773 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2775 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2776 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2777 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2778 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2779 test data. A line history is supported.
2781 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2782 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2783 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2784 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2785 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2786 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2787 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2789 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2790 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2791 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2792 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2794 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2795 defined and macros will be expanded.
2796 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2797 available to admin users.
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3053 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3054 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3055 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3056 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3057 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3058 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3060 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3061 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3062 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3063 This option requires admin privileges.
3065 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3066 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3067 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3071 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3072 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3073 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3074 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3075 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3076 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3077 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3079 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3080 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3081 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3082 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3083 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3085 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3086 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3087 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3088 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3093 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3094 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3095 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3096 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3097 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3098 arguments, for example:
3100 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3102 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3103 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3104 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3105 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3106 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3107 users, the output is as in this example:
3109 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3111 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3112 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3114 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3115 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3116 backward compatibility.)
3117 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3118 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3120 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3121 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3122 name will not be output.
3124 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3125 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3126 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3127 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3128 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3129 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3130 written directly into the spool directory.
3132 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3134 exim -bP +local_domains
3136 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3137 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3139 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3140 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3141 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3142 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3143 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3144 that driver are output. For example:
3146 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3148 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3149 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3150 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3151 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3152 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3155 .cindex "environment"
3156 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3157 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3160 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3161 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3162 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3163 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3164 The output format is one item per line.
3166 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3167 the exit status will be nonzero.
3172 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3173 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3174 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3175 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3176 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3177 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3178 to allow any user to see the queue.
3180 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3182 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3183 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3186 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3187 .cindex "size" "of message"
3188 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3189 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3190 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3191 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3192 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3193 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3194 before the sender address.
3196 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3197 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3198 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3200 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3201 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3202 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3203 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3204 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3210 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3211 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3212 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3218 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3219 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3220 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3221 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3226 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3227 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3228 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3229 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3233 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3237 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3242 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3243 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3244 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3245 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3250 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3251 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3252 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3253 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3254 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3256 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3257 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3259 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3260 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3261 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3262 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3263 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3264 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3265 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3266 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3267 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3269 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3270 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3275 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3276 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3277 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3278 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3279 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3280 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3281 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3285 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3286 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3287 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3288 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3289 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3290 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3291 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3292 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3293 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3295 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3296 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3297 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3299 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3300 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3301 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3302 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3304 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3305 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3306 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3308 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3309 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3310 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3311 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3312 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3314 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3315 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3319 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3320 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3321 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3322 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3323 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3324 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3325 messages to the MTA.
3328 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3329 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3330 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3331 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3332 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3333 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3334 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3338 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3339 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3340 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3341 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3342 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3343 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3344 the listening daemon.
3348 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3349 .cindex "address" "testing"
3350 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3351 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3352 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3353 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3354 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3356 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3357 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3359 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3360 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3363 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3364 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3365 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3366 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3367 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3370 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3371 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3372 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3373 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3375 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3376 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3377 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3378 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3381 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3382 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3384 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3385 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3386 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3387 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3388 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3389 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3394 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3395 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3396 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3397 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3398 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3399 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3401 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3402 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3403 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3404 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3405 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3406 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3407 dynamic testing facilities.
3411 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3412 .cindex "address" "verification"
3413 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3414 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3415 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3416 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3417 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3418 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3420 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3421 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3422 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3424 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3425 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3427 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3428 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3431 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3432 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3433 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3434 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3435 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3437 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3438 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3439 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3440 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3441 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3442 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3445 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3446 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3447 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3450 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3451 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3452 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3453 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3455 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3456 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3457 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3458 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3462 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3463 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3470 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3471 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3472 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3473 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3475 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3476 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3477 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3478 each port only when the first connection is received.
3480 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3481 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3483 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3485 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3486 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3487 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3488 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3489 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3490 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3491 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3492 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3493 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3495 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3496 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3497 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3498 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3499 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3500 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3501 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3502 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3503 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3505 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3506 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3507 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3508 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3509 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3510 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3511 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3513 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3514 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3515 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3516 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3517 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3518 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3519 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3521 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3522 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3523 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3526 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3527 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3528 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3529 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3530 specified by this option.
3533 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3535 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3536 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3537 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3538 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3539 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3540 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3542 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3543 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3544 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3545 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3546 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3547 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3548 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3550 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3551 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3552 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3558 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3559 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3562 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3564 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3565 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3568 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3570 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3571 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3572 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3573 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3574 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3575 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3576 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3579 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3580 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3581 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3582 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3583 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3584 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3585 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3588 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3589 &`auth `& authenticators
3590 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3591 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3592 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3593 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3594 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3595 &`filter `& filter handling
3596 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3597 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3598 &`ident `& ident lookup
3599 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3600 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3601 &`load `& system load checks
3602 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3603 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3604 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3605 &`memory `& memory handling
3606 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3607 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3608 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3609 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3610 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3611 &`retry `& retry handling
3612 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3613 &`route `& address routing
3614 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3616 &`transport `& transports
3617 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3618 &`verify `& address verification logic
3619 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3621 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3622 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3623 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3624 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3625 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3626 turn everything off.
3628 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3629 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3630 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3631 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3632 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3635 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3636 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3637 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3638 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3639 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3642 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3643 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3646 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3647 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3649 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3651 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3652 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3653 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3654 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3657 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3658 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3659 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3660 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3664 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3665 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3666 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3667 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3668 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3669 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3670 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3671 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3674 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3675 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3676 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3677 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3678 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3680 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3682 .cindex "sender" "name"
3683 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3684 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3685 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3686 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3687 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3688 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3690 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3692 .cindex "sender" "address"
3693 .cindex "address" "sender"
3694 .cindex "trusted users"
3695 .cindex "envelope sender"
3696 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3697 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3698 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3699 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3702 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3703 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3704 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3705 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3708 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3709 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3710 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3711 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3712 examples of shell commands:
3714 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3715 exim -f "" user@domain
3717 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3718 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3721 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3722 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3723 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3724 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3727 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3728 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3729 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3730 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3731 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3732 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3736 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3737 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3739 control = suppress_local_fixups
3741 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3742 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3745 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3748 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3750 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3751 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3752 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3757 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3758 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3759 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3760 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3761 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3762 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3764 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3766 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3767 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3768 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3769 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3770 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3771 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3773 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3775 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3777 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3778 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3779 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3780 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3781 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3782 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3783 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3786 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3787 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3788 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3789 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3790 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3791 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3793 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3794 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3795 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3796 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3798 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3800 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3801 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3802 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3803 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3804 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3805 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3806 can be used only by an admin user.
3808 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3809 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3811 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3812 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3813 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3814 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3815 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3816 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3817 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3818 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3822 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3823 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3824 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3828 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3829 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3830 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3832 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3834 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3835 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3836 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3840 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3841 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3842 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3846 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3847 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3848 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3850 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3852 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3853 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3854 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3855 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3856 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3857 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3861 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3862 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3863 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3868 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3869 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3870 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3872 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3874 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3875 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3876 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3877 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3879 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3881 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3882 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3883 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3884 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3885 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3886 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3887 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3888 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3889 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3890 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3891 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3892 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3893 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3895 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3897 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3898 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3899 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3900 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3901 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3902 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3903 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3904 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3906 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3908 .cindex "freezing messages"
3909 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3910 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3911 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3912 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3913 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3914 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3917 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3919 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3920 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3921 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3922 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3923 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3924 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3925 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3926 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3929 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3931 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3932 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3933 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3934 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3935 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3937 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3939 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3940 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3941 .cindex "removing recipients"
3942 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3943 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3944 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3945 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3946 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3947 can be used only by an admin user.
3949 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3951 .cindex "removing messages"
3952 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3953 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3954 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3955 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3956 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3957 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3958 placed on the queue.
3960 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3962 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3963 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3964 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3965 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3966 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3967 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3968 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3969 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3970 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3972 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3974 .cindex "thawing messages"
3975 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3976 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3977 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3978 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3979 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3980 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3983 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3985 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3986 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3987 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3988 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3990 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3992 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3993 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3994 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3995 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3996 only by an admin user.
3998 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4000 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4001 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4002 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4003 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4004 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4006 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4008 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4009 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4010 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4011 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4015 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4016 treats it that way too.
4020 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4021 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4022 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4023 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4024 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4025 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4026 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4029 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4030 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4031 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4032 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4033 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4034 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4035 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4040 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4041 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4042 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4043 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4045 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4047 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4050 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4052 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4053 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4054 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4057 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4059 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4060 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4061 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4062 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4063 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4064 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4068 .cindex "background delivery"
4069 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4070 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4071 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4072 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4073 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4074 processes to finish.
4076 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4077 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4078 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4079 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4081 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4082 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4083 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4084 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4088 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4089 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4090 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4091 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4092 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4093 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4095 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4096 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4099 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4100 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4102 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4103 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4104 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4105 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4110 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4115 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4116 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4117 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4118 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4119 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4120 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4121 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4122 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4123 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4124 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4129 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4130 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4131 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4132 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4133 configuration file is in effect.
4135 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4136 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4137 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4138 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4139 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4140 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4141 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4142 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4143 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4148 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4149 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4150 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4153 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4155 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4156 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4157 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4158 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4162 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4163 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4164 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4165 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4166 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4170 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4171 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4172 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4173 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4174 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4178 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4179 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4184 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4185 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4190 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4191 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4192 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4193 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4194 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4195 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4198 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4199 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4201 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4203 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4204 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4205 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4206 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4207 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4208 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4210 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4211 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4213 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4215 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4216 followed by a colon and the port number:
4218 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4220 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4221 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4222 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4223 whichever one is last.
4225 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4227 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4228 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4229 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4230 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4231 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4232 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4234 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4236 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4237 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4238 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4239 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4240 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4241 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4243 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4245 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4246 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4247 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4248 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4249 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4250 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4251 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4252 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4254 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4256 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4257 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4258 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4259 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4260 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4262 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4264 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4265 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4266 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4267 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4268 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4269 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4270 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4272 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4273 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4274 is sending the bounce.
4276 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4278 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4279 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4280 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4281 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4282 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4283 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4284 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4285 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4286 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4287 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4289 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4291 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4292 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4293 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4294 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4295 uses the name it is given.
4297 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4299 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4300 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4301 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4302 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4303 used, when there is no default.
4307 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4308 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4309 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4310 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4314 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4315 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4316 whatever that means.
4318 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4320 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4321 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4322 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4323 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4324 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4325 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4326 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4328 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4330 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4331 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4332 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4333 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4334 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4336 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4338 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4339 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4340 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4341 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4342 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4343 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4347 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4349 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4351 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4352 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4353 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4354 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4355 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4356 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4357 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4358 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4362 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4363 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4364 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4365 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4370 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4371 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4372 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4373 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4376 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4378 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4380 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4382 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4383 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4384 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4385 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4386 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4387 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4391 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4392 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4393 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4394 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4395 and &%-S%& options).
4397 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4398 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4399 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4400 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4401 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4402 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4403 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4406 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4407 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4408 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4409 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4410 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4413 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4414 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4415 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4416 this to be repeated periodically.
4418 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4419 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4420 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4421 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4423 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4424 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4425 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4427 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4428 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4429 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4430 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4434 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4435 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4436 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4437 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4438 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4439 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4442 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4443 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4444 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4445 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4446 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4447 delivered down a single SMTP
4448 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4449 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4450 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4451 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4452 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4455 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4457 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4458 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4459 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4460 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4461 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4463 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4465 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4466 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4467 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4468 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4469 their retry times are tried.
4471 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4473 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4474 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4477 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4479 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4480 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4481 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4484 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4487 .cindex "named queues"
4488 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4489 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4490 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4491 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4492 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4493 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4495 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4496 will specify a queue to operate on.
4499 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4501 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4504 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4505 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4506 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4507 starting message id. For example:
4509 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4511 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4512 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4513 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4515 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4517 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4518 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4519 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4520 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4521 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4522 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4524 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4525 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4526 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4527 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4528 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4529 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4530 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4531 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4532 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4534 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4536 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4537 process every 30 minutes.
4539 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4540 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4542 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4544 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4547 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4549 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4551 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4553 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4554 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4555 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4556 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4557 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4558 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4559 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4561 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4562 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4563 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4564 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4565 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4566 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4568 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4569 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4571 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4573 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4574 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4575 applied to each queue run.
4577 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4578 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4579 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4580 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4581 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4582 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4583 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4584 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4585 address will be skipped.
4587 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4588 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4589 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4592 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4593 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4594 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4595 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4596 an arbitrary command instead.
4600 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4602 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4604 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4605 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4606 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4607 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4608 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4609 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4611 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4613 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4614 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4615 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4619 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4620 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4621 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4622 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4623 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4624 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4625 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4626 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4627 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4629 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4630 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4631 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4632 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4633 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4634 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4635 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4636 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4637 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4638 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4639 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4641 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4642 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4643 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4644 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4645 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4646 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4648 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4649 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4650 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4651 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4652 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4653 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4654 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4655 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4656 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4660 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4661 compatibility with Sendmail.
4663 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4664 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4665 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4666 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4667 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4668 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4669 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4670 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4675 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4676 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4677 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4678 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4679 set. Exim ignores this option.
4683 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4684 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4685 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4686 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4687 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4688 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4693 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4694 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4695 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4698 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4700 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4701 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4703 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4705 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4706 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4707 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4716 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4717 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4718 . creates a man page for the options.
4719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4722 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4733 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4734 "The runtime configuration file"
4736 .cindex "run time configuration"
4737 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4738 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4739 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4740 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4741 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4742 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4743 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4744 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4747 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4748 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4749 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4750 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4751 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4752 actually alter the string.
4754 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4755 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4756 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4757 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4758 existing file in the list.
4761 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4762 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4763 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4764 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4765 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4766 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4767 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4768 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4769 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4770 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4772 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4773 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4774 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4775 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4776 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4778 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4779 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4780 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4781 compromise the Exim user account.
4783 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4784 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4785 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4786 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4787 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4788 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4793 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4794 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4795 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4796 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4797 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4798 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4799 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4800 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4801 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4802 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4803 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4805 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4806 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4807 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4808 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4809 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4810 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4811 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4812 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4813 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4816 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4817 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4818 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4819 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4820 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4822 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4823 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4824 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4825 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4826 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4827 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4829 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4830 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4831 necessarily be discarded.
4832 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4833 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4834 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4835 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4836 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4837 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4839 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4840 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4841 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4842 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4843 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4844 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4845 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4847 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4848 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4849 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4853 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4854 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4855 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4856 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4857 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4858 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4859 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4860 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4863 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4866 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4867 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4868 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4870 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4871 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4872 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4874 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4875 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4876 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4878 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4879 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4880 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4881 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4884 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4885 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4886 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4888 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4889 want to use this feature, you must set
4891 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4893 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4894 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4897 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4898 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4899 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4900 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4902 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4903 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4904 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4905 and does not introduce a comment.
4907 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4908 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4909 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4910 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4911 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4913 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4914 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4915 change settings as required.
4917 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4918 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4919 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4920 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4921 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4926 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4927 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4928 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4929 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4930 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4931 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4934 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4935 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4937 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4938 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4939 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4940 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4941 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4944 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4945 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4946 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4947 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4949 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4950 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4953 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4956 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4957 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4962 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4963 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4964 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4965 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4966 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4967 definition, and must be of the form
4969 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4971 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4972 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4973 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4974 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4975 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4977 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4978 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4979 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4981 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4982 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4983 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4984 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4985 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4986 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4987 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4990 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4991 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4993 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4994 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4995 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4996 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4997 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4998 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5001 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5002 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5003 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5008 MAC == updated value
5010 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5011 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5012 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5013 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5017 MAC == MAC and something added
5019 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5020 from a number of other files.
5022 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5023 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5024 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5025 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5026 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5031 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5032 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5033 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5034 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5036 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5037 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5039 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5041 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5043 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5044 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5045 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5048 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5049 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5050 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5051 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5052 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5055 The following classes of macros are defined:
5057 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5058 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5059 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5060 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5061 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5062 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5063 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5064 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5065 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5066 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5067 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5070 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5073 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5074 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5075 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5076 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5077 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5078 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5079 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5081 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5082 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5083 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5087 message_size_limit = 50M
5089 message_size_limit = 100M
5092 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5093 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5094 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5095 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5096 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5098 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5099 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5100 in this line"& will always be true.
5102 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5103 to clarify complicated nestings.
5107 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5108 .cindex "common option syntax"
5109 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5110 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5111 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5112 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5113 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5114 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5115 space) and then the value. For example:
5117 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5119 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5120 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5121 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5122 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5123 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5124 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5125 word &"hide"&. For example:
5127 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5129 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5131 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5133 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5134 all instances of the same driver.
5136 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5137 that are found in option settings.
5140 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5141 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5142 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5143 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5144 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5145 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5146 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5147 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5148 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5149 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5150 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5151 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5156 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5161 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5166 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5167 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5168 .cindex "format" "integer"
5169 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5170 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5171 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5172 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5175 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5176 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5177 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5179 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5180 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5181 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5185 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5186 .cindex "integer format"
5187 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5188 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5189 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5190 Such options are always output in octal.
5193 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5194 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5195 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5196 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5197 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5201 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5202 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5203 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5204 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5205 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5215 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5216 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5217 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5221 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5222 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5223 .cindex "format" "string"
5224 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5225 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5226 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5227 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5228 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5229 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5230 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5231 therefore equivalent:
5233 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5234 trusted_users = uucp:\
5235 # This comment line is ignored
5238 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5239 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5240 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5241 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5242 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5245 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5246 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5247 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5249 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5250 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5254 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5255 character, that character replaces the pair.
5257 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5258 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5259 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5260 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5261 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5262 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5265 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5266 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5267 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5268 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5269 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5270 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5271 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5272 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5273 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5274 within a quoted configuration string.
5277 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5278 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5279 .cindex "format" "user name"
5280 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5281 .cindex "format" "group name"
5282 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5283 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5284 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5285 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5288 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5289 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5290 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5291 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5292 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5293 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5294 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5295 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5296 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5297 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5298 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5300 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5301 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5302 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5303 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5304 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5305 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5308 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5310 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5312 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5313 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5314 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5315 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5317 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5318 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5319 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5320 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5321 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5322 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5323 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5324 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5326 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5328 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5329 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5330 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5332 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5333 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5334 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5335 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5336 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5337 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5338 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5339 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5340 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5342 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5344 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5345 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5346 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5347 the value in quotes. For example:
5349 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5351 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5352 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5353 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5354 enclosing an empty list item.
5358 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5359 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5360 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5361 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5363 senders = user@domain :
5365 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5366 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5367 items, the second of which is empty:
5369 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5371 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5372 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5373 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5374 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5378 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5379 is at the end of the list.
5384 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5385 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5386 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5387 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5388 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5389 a sequence of lines like this:
5391 <&'instance name'&>:
5396 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5397 followed by three options settings:
5402 transport = local_delivery
5404 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5405 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5406 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5407 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5408 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5409 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5411 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5412 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5414 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5415 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5416 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5417 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5418 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5421 .cindex "generic options"
5422 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5423 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5424 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5425 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5426 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5427 .cindex "private options"
5428 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5429 they all have default values.
5431 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5432 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5433 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5435 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5436 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5437 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5438 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5439 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5440 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5441 configuration lines:
5446 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5447 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5448 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5449 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5455 command_timeout = 10s
5457 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5458 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5461 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5462 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5463 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5471 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5472 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5474 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5475 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5476 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5477 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5478 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5479 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5480 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5481 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5482 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5483 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5484 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5488 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5489 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5490 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5493 # primary_hostname =
5495 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5496 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5497 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5498 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5500 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5502 domainlist local_domains = @
5503 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5504 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5506 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5507 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5508 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5509 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5511 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5512 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5515 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5516 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5517 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5518 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5519 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5520 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5522 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5523 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5524 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5525 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5526 domain is permitted.
5528 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5529 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5530 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5531 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5532 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5533 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5535 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5536 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5537 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5539 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5541 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5542 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5544 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5545 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5546 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5547 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5548 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5549 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5550 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5551 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5552 contents of a message to be checked.
5554 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5556 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5557 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5559 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5560 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5561 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5562 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5564 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5566 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5567 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5568 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5570 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5571 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5572 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5573 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5574 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5575 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5576 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5578 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5580 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5581 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5583 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5584 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5585 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5586 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5587 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5588 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5589 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5590 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5591 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5592 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5593 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5594 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5595 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5596 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5597 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5598 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5600 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5601 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5602 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5603 which should be used in preference to 587.
5604 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5606 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5608 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5611 # qualify_recipient =
5613 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5614 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5615 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5616 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5617 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5618 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5620 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5621 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5622 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5623 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5625 # allow_domain_literals
5627 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5628 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5629 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5630 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5631 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5632 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5634 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5638 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5639 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5640 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5641 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5642 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5643 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5644 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5645 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5647 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5648 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5653 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5654 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5655 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5656 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5657 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5658 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5661 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5662 1413 (hence their names):
5665 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5667 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5668 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5669 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5670 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5671 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5672 information, you can change this.
5674 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5675 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5680 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5681 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5682 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5683 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5685 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5686 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5688 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5689 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5691 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5694 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5695 +tls_certificate_verified
5698 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5700 # percent_hack_domains =
5702 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5703 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5704 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5706 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5707 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5708 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5709 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5710 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5711 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5712 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5713 always bounce messages.
5715 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5716 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5718 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5719 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5720 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5721 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5722 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5724 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5725 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5726 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5727 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5728 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5731 # split_spool_directory = true
5734 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5735 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5736 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5737 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5738 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5739 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5740 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5742 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5745 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5746 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5747 that are not 8-bit clean.
5749 # accept_8bitmime = false
5752 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5753 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5754 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5755 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5756 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5757 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5759 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5760 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5764 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5765 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5766 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5767 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5768 It starts with the line
5772 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5773 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5774 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5776 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5777 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5778 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5779 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5780 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5781 result of the ACL processing.
5785 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5790 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5791 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5792 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5793 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5794 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5795 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5797 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5798 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5799 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5802 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5803 domains = +local_domains
5804 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5806 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5807 domains = !+local_domains
5808 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5810 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5811 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5812 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5813 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5814 in Internet mail addresses.
5816 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5817 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5818 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5819 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5820 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5821 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5822 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5823 policy of being as safe as possible.
5825 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5826 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5827 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5828 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5829 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5830 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5832 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5833 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5834 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5835 have to modify this rule.
5837 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5838 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5839 common convention of local parts constructed as
5840 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5841 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5842 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5843 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5844 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5845 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5847 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5848 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5849 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5850 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5851 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5852 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5853 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5855 accept local_parts = postmaster
5856 domains = +local_domains
5858 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5859 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5860 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5861 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5862 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5864 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5865 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5866 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5868 require verify = sender
5870 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5871 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5872 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5873 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5874 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5875 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5876 discusses the details of address verification.
5878 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5879 control = submission
5881 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5882 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5883 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5884 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5885 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5886 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5887 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5888 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5889 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5891 accept authenticated = *
5892 control = submission
5894 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5895 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5896 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5897 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5898 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5899 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5901 require message = relay not permitted
5902 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5904 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5905 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5907 require verify = recipient
5909 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5910 fails, the address is rejected.
5912 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5913 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5915 # dnslists = black.list.example
5917 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5918 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5919 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5920 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5922 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5923 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5924 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5927 # require verify = csa
5929 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5930 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5935 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5936 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5940 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5941 of this ACL are commented out:
5944 # message = This message contains a virus \
5947 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5948 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5949 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5950 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5952 # warn spam = nobody
5953 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5954 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5955 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5956 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5958 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5959 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5960 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5961 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5962 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5963 whatever the spam score.
5967 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5970 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5971 .cindex "default" "routers"
5972 .cindex "routers" "default"
5973 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5978 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5979 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5980 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5981 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5982 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5985 # driver = ipliteral
5986 # domains = !+local_domains
5987 # transport = remote_smtp
5989 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5990 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5991 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5992 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5993 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5997 domains = ! +local_domains
5998 transport = remote_smtp
5999 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6002 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
6003 domains. This is specified by the line
6005 domains = ! +local_domains
6007 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6008 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6009 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6010 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6011 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6012 passed on to the following routers.
6014 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6015 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6016 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6017 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6018 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6020 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6021 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6022 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6023 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6024 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6025 the address fails and is bounced.
6027 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6028 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6029 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6030 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6031 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6032 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6033 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6040 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6042 file_transport = address_file
6043 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6045 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6046 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6047 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6048 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6049 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6052 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6053 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6054 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6055 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6060 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6061 # local_part_suffix_optional
6062 file = $home/.forward
6067 file_transport = address_file
6068 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6069 reply_transport = address_reply
6071 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6072 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6073 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6074 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6075 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6078 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6079 # local_part_suffix_optional
6081 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6082 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6083 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6084 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6085 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6086 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6087 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6089 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6090 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6091 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6092 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6094 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6095 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6096 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6097 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6098 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6099 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6100 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6102 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6103 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6104 There are two reasons for doing this:
6107 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6108 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6111 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6112 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6113 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6114 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6118 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6119 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6120 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6121 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6123 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6124 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6125 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6127 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6129 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6135 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6136 # local_part_suffix_optional
6137 transport = local_delivery
6139 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6140 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6141 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6142 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6143 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6146 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6147 .cindex "default" "transports"
6148 .cindex "transports" "default"
6149 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6150 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6151 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6155 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6161 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6162 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6163 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6164 It is negotiated between client and server
6165 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6166 All other options are defaulted.
6170 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6177 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6178 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6179 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6180 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6181 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6182 show how this can be done.
6184 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6185 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6186 similarly-named options above.
6192 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6193 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6194 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6195 be returned to the sender.
6203 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6204 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6205 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6210 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6215 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6216 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6217 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6218 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6219 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6220 introduced by the line
6224 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6227 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6229 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6230 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6231 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6232 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6233 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6235 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6236 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6237 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6240 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6241 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6245 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6246 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6250 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6251 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6252 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6254 begin authenticators
6256 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6257 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6258 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6259 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6260 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6261 to support most MUA software.
6263 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6266 # driver = plaintext
6267 # server_set_id = $auth2
6268 # server_prompts = :
6269 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6270 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6272 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6275 # driver = plaintext
6276 # server_set_id = $auth1
6277 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6278 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6279 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6282 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6283 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6284 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6285 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6286 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6287 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6288 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6289 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6291 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6292 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6293 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6294 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6296 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6297 usercode and password are in different positions.
6298 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6300 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6304 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6305 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6307 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6309 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6311 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6312 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6313 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6314 regular expressions is discussed in
6315 online Perl manpages, in
6316 many Perl reference books, and also in
6317 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6318 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6320 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6321 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6322 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6323 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6324 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6327 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6328 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6329 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6330 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6332 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6334 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6335 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6336 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6337 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6338 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6339 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6342 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6343 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6344 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6345 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6346 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6347 match anywhere in the subject string.
6349 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6350 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6352 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6354 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6357 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6359 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6360 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6364 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6365 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6367 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6368 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6369 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6370 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6371 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6372 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6375 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6376 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6377 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6378 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6379 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6380 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6382 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6383 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6384 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6385 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6386 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6387 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6390 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6391 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6392 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6393 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6394 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6395 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6397 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6398 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6399 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6400 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6401 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6403 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6404 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6406 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6407 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6408 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6409 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6410 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6412 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6413 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6415 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6416 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6418 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6419 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6420 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6425 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6426 matches the list item.
6428 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6429 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6431 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6433 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6434 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6435 causes a second lookup to occur.
6437 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6438 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6439 lookup is permitted.
6442 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6443 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6444 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6445 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6448 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6449 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6450 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6452 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6453 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6454 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6455 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6458 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6459 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6460 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6465 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6466 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6467 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6472 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6473 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6474 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6475 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6478 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6479 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6480 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6481 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6482 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6483 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6484 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6485 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6486 be found in several places:
6488 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6489 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6490 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6492 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6493 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6494 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6495 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6497 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6498 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6499 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6500 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6501 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6502 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6503 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6505 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6506 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6507 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6508 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6509 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6510 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6511 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6513 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6514 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6516 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6517 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6518 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6519 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6520 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6521 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6522 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6524 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6525 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6526 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6528 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6529 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6530 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6531 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6532 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6533 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6534 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6535 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6536 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6537 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6539 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6540 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6541 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6542 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6543 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6544 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6545 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6546 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6547 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6549 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6550 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6551 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6552 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6553 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6554 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6555 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6557 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6558 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6559 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6560 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6562 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6563 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6564 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6565 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6566 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6568 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6569 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6570 lookup types support only literal keys.
6572 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6573 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6574 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6576 .cindex "linear search"
6577 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6578 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6579 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6580 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6581 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6582 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6583 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6584 in the file is used.
6586 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6587 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6588 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6589 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6590 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6595 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6596 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6597 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6598 wildcarding of any kind.
6600 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6601 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6602 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6603 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6604 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6605 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6606 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6607 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6608 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6611 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6612 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6613 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6614 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6615 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6616 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6617 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6618 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6621 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6622 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6623 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6624 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6625 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6626 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6627 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6628 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6629 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6631 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6632 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6633 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6634 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6636 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6637 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6640 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6642 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6643 *fish data for anythingfish
6646 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6647 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6649 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6651 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6652 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6653 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6655 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6657 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6658 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6659 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6661 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6664 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6665 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6666 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6667 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6668 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6670 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6671 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6672 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6673 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6674 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6677 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6678 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6679 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6682 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6684 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6687 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6688 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6689 be followed by optional colons.
6691 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6692 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6693 lookup types support only literal keys.
6697 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6698 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6699 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6700 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6701 many of them are given in later sections.
6704 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6705 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6706 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6707 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6708 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6710 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6711 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6712 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6714 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6715 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6716 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6717 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6718 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6719 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6720 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6722 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6723 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6724 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6725 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6727 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6728 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6729 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6730 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6732 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6733 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6734 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6735 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6737 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6738 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6739 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6740 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6741 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6742 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6743 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6744 password value. For example:
6746 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6749 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6750 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6751 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6752 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6755 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6756 .cindex lookup Redis
6757 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6758 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6761 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6762 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6763 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6764 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6767 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6768 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6770 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6771 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6772 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6773 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6774 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6775 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6776 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6777 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6778 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6780 require condition = \
6781 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6783 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6784 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6785 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6786 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6791 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6792 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6793 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6794 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6795 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6796 options such as a list of local domains.
6798 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6799 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6800 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6801 or may give up altogether.
6805 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6806 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6807 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6808 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6809 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6810 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6811 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6812 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6814 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6815 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6816 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6818 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6819 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6820 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6822 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6823 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6824 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6825 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6826 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6827 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6828 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6829 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6830 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6831 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6833 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6835 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6836 looks up these keys, in this order:
6842 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6843 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6844 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6845 Exim move on to try the next key.
6849 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6850 .cindex "partial matching"
6851 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6852 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6853 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6854 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6855 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6856 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6857 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6858 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6859 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6860 a key in a DBM file is
6862 *.dates.fict.example
6864 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6865 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6866 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6869 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6870 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6871 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6873 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6874 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6875 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6876 partial matching keys
6877 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6878 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6879 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6881 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6882 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6883 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6884 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6885 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6886 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6889 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6890 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6891 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6892 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6893 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6894 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6896 2250.dates.fict.example
6897 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6898 *.dates.fict.example
6901 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6904 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6905 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6906 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6907 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6908 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6909 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6911 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6913 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6914 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6915 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6916 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6918 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6920 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6921 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6923 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6924 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6925 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6928 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6930 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6931 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6933 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6934 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6935 for &"*"& on its own.
6937 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6941 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6942 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6943 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6944 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6945 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6946 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6947 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6949 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6950 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6951 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6952 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6953 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6958 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6959 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6960 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6961 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6962 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6963 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6964 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6966 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6967 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6968 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6969 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6970 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6971 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6973 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6974 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6980 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6981 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6982 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6983 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6984 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6985 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6989 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6990 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6992 [name="$local_part"]
6994 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6995 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6996 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6997 of the following form is provided:
6999 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7001 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7003 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7005 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7006 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7007 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7012 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7013 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7014 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7015 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7016 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7017 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7018 an expansion string could contain:
7020 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7022 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7023 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7024 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7025 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7027 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7028 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7029 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7031 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7032 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7033 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7034 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7035 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7037 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7039 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7040 white space is ignored.
7041 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7042 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7043 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7045 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7046 When the type is PTR,
7047 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7048 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7050 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7052 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7053 altered and nothing is added.
7055 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7056 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7057 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7058 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7059 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7060 The field separator can be modified as above.
7062 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7063 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7064 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7065 unless a field separator is specified.
7066 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7068 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7070 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7071 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7072 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7074 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7075 white space is ignored.
7077 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7078 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7079 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7080 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7083 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7086 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7087 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7088 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7089 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7090 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7091 each followed by a comma,
7092 that may appear before the record type.
7094 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7095 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7096 a defer-option modifier.
7097 The possible keywords are
7098 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7099 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7100 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7101 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7102 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7103 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7104 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7106 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7107 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7109 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7110 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7112 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7113 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7114 The possible keywords are
7115 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7116 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7118 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7119 is not labelled as authenticated data
7120 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7121 The default is &"never"&.
7123 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7125 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7126 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7127 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7128 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7130 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7132 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7133 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7134 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7136 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7137 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7139 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7140 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7141 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7144 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7145 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7146 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7147 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7148 the pseudo-type MXH:
7150 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7152 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7155 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7156 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7157 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7158 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7159 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7160 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7161 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7162 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7164 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7165 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7167 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7168 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7169 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7171 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7172 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7173 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7174 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7175 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7178 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7179 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7180 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7181 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7182 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7183 result of a successful lookup such as:
7185 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7187 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7188 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7189 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7191 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7192 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7193 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7194 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7196 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7200 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7201 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7202 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7203 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7204 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7206 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7207 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7208 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7210 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7211 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7212 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7213 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7215 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7216 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7217 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7222 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7223 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7224 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7225 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7226 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7227 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7228 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7229 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7230 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7231 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7232 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7233 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7235 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7236 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7237 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7238 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7239 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7241 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7242 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7244 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7245 the way they handle the results of a query:
7248 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7251 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7252 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7254 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7255 from all of them are returned.
7259 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7260 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7261 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7262 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7265 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7266 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7267 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7268 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7270 data = ${lookup ldap \
7271 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7272 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7274 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7275 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7276 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7277 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7279 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7280 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7281 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7283 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7284 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7285 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7286 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7287 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7288 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7289 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7290 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7294 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7295 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7296 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7297 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7298 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7299 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7301 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7302 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7310 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7311 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7315 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7317 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7321 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7323 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7325 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7327 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7328 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7329 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7333 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7334 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7335 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7337 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7341 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7343 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7345 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7347 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7348 authentication below.
7351 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7352 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7353 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7354 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7355 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7358 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7360 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7361 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7362 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7363 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7364 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7365 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7366 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7367 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7368 failures, and timeouts.
7370 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7371 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7372 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7373 doubled. For example
7375 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7377 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7378 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7379 the local host) is used.
7381 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7382 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7383 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7384 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7387 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7388 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7389 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7390 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7392 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7394 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7395 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7397 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7399 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7400 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7401 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7402 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7403 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7404 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7405 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7408 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7409 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7410 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7413 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7416 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7420 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7421 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7425 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7426 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7427 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7428 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7429 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7430 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7431 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7432 them. The following names are recognized:
7434 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7435 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7436 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7437 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7438 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7439 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7440 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7441 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7443 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7444 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7445 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7446 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7448 .cindex LDAP timeout
7449 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7450 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7451 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7452 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7453 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7454 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7455 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7456 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7457 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7458 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7460 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7461 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7463 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7464 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7465 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7466 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7467 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7468 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7469 alternate list (colon-separated).
7471 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7472 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7475 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7476 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7479 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7480 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7481 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7482 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7484 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7485 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7486 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7488 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7489 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7490 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7491 quoting has two advantages:
7494 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7495 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7497 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7500 For example, a setting such as
7502 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7504 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7506 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7507 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7508 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7509 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7513 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7514 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7519 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7520 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7521 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7522 as a sequence of values, for example
7524 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7526 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7527 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7528 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7529 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7530 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7533 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7534 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7535 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7536 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7538 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7539 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7540 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7541 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7542 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7543 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7544 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7545 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7546 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7548 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7549 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7550 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7551 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7552 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7555 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7558 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7561 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7562 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7564 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7565 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7567 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7568 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7571 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7572 results of LDAP lookups.
7573 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7574 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7575 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7576 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7577 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7578 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7583 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7584 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7585 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7586 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7587 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7588 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7589 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7590 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7592 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7594 might return the string
7596 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7597 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7599 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7601 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7607 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7608 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7609 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7613 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7614 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7615 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7616 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7617 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7618 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7619 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7620 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7621 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7622 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7623 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7624 .cindex lookup Redis
7625 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7627 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7630 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7633 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7634 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7636 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7641 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7643 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7644 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7645 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7649 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7650 with a newline between the data for each row.
7653 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7654 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7655 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7656 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7657 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7658 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7659 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7660 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7661 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7662 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7663 .cindex lookup Redis
7664 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7665 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7666 or &%redis_servers%&
7667 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7669 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7670 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7671 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7673 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7674 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7675 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7676 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7678 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7680 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7681 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7682 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7684 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7685 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7687 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7688 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7689 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7690 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7691 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7692 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7694 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7695 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7696 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7698 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7699 host, database number, and password.
7701 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7702 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7703 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7705 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7707 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7710 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7711 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7712 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7713 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7715 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7716 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7718 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7719 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7720 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7721 done by starting the query with
7723 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7725 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7727 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7728 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7729 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7732 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7734 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7735 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7736 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7738 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7739 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7740 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7743 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7747 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7749 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7751 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7752 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7753 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7755 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7759 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7760 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7761 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7762 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7763 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7764 the default value is &"exim"&.
7765 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7767 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7768 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7770 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7771 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7773 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7776 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7777 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7779 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7780 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7781 is zero because no rows are affected.
7784 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7785 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7786 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7787 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7788 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7791 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7793 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7794 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7795 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7797 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7798 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7801 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7802 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7803 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7804 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7805 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7806 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7807 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7808 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7809 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7811 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7812 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7814 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7816 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7817 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7819 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7820 quote, which it doubles.
7822 .cindex timeout SQLite
7823 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7824 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7825 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7826 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7827 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7828 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7829 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7832 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7833 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7834 .cindex "redis lookup type"
7835 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7838 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7839 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7843 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
7844 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
7845 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
7846 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
7849 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, exim does not
7850 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
7851 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
7859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7862 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7863 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7864 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7865 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7866 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7867 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7868 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7869 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7870 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7872 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7873 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7874 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7875 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7877 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7878 support all the complexity available in
7879 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7883 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7884 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7885 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7887 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7888 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7891 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7892 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7893 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7894 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7895 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7898 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7899 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7900 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7902 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7903 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7904 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7905 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7906 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7908 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7909 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7911 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7912 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7913 senders based on the receiving domain.
7918 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7919 .cindex "list" "negation"
7920 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7921 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7922 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7923 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7924 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7925 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7927 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7928 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7929 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7930 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7931 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7933 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7935 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7936 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7937 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7939 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7941 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7942 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7943 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7945 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7946 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7951 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7952 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7953 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7954 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7955 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7956 file names are not allowed,
7957 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7958 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7962 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7963 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7965 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7966 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7967 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7969 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7973 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7974 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7975 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7976 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7978 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7979 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7981 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7983 and the file contains the lines
7988 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7989 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7993 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7994 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7995 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7996 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7997 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7998 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7999 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8000 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8002 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8003 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
8004 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8005 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8010 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8011 .cindex "named lists"
8012 .cindex "list" "named"
8013 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8014 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8015 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8016 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8017 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8018 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8019 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8021 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8023 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8024 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8025 configured with the line
8027 domains = +local_domains
8029 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8030 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8034 domains = ! +local_domains
8035 transport = remote_smtp
8038 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8039 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8040 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8041 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8043 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8044 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8046 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8048 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8049 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8050 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8052 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8053 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8054 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8056 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8057 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8059 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8060 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8061 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8063 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8065 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8066 referenced lists if you can.
8068 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8069 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8070 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8072 domains = +local_domains
8074 on several of your routers
8075 or in several ACL statements,
8076 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8077 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8078 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8079 the same each time they are referenced.
8081 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8082 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8083 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8084 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8088 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8089 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8090 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8091 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8092 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8095 ALIST = host1 : host2
8096 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8098 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8100 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8102 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8105 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8106 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8108 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8110 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8114 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8115 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8116 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8117 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8118 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8119 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8120 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8121 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8122 message. For example:
8124 domainlist special_domains = \
8125 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8127 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8128 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8129 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8130 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8131 same list each time.
8133 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8134 cache the result anyway. For example:
8136 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8138 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8139 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8143 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8144 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8145 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8146 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8147 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8150 .cindex "primary host name"
8151 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8152 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8153 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8154 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8155 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8156 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8157 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8158 differ only in their names.
8160 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8161 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8162 .cindex "domain literal"
8163 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8164 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8165 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8166 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8167 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8168 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8171 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8172 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8173 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8174 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8175 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8176 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8177 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8178 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8179 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8180 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8181 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8183 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8184 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8185 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8186 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8187 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8189 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8190 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8191 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8192 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8193 on a router). For example:
8195 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8197 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8198 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8200 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8201 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8202 contain negative items.
8204 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8205 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8206 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8208 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8209 an.other.domain : ...
8211 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8212 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8214 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8215 an.other.domain ? ...
8218 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8219 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8220 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8221 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8222 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8223 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8224 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8225 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8226 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8230 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8231 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8232 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8233 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8234 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8235 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8236 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8237 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8238 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8240 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8241 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8242 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8243 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8244 expression by expansion, of course).
8246 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8247 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8248 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8249 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8250 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8251 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8253 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8255 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8256 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8257 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8258 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8259 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8260 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8261 other statements in the same ACL.
8264 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8265 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8267 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8269 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8270 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8273 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8274 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8275 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8276 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8277 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8278 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8281 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8282 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8283 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8284 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8286 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8287 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8289 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8290 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8291 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8292 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8293 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8295 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8296 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8297 between the pattern and the domain.
8300 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8302 domainlist funny_domains = \
8305 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8306 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8307 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8308 nis;domains.byname : \
8309 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8311 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8312 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8313 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8314 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8315 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8320 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8321 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8322 .cindex "list" "host list"
8323 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8324 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8325 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8326 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8327 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8328 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8329 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8332 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8333 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8334 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8335 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8336 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8337 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8340 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8341 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8342 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8346 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8347 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8348 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8349 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8350 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8351 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8352 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8355 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8356 inspecting its IP address:
8359 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8360 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8361 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8362 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8363 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8364 with the IP address of the subject host.
8366 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8367 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8368 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8369 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8370 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8373 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8374 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8375 domain name, as just described.
8378 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8379 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8380 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8381 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8382 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8383 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8384 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8385 that can never match a client host.
8388 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8389 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8390 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8391 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8393 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8397 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8398 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8399 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8400 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8401 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8402 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8403 significant end of the address.
8405 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8406 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8407 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8408 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8412 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8413 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8416 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8418 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8419 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8421 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8422 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8425 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8427 could make use of a file containing
8432 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8433 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8434 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8436 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8439 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8445 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8446 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8447 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8448 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8449 address, the pattern takes this form:
8451 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8455 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8457 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8458 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8459 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8460 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8461 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8462 returned by the lookup is not used.
8464 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8465 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8466 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8467 patterns of this form:
8469 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8473 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8475 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8476 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8477 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8478 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8479 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8481 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8482 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8483 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8484 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8485 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8486 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8487 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8488 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8489 addresses are always used.
8491 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8492 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8493 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8496 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8497 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8498 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8499 case the IP address is used on its own.
8503 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8504 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8505 .cindex "unknown host name"
8506 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8507 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8508 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8509 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8510 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8513 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8514 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8515 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8516 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8517 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8518 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8519 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8521 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8522 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8524 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8525 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8526 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8527 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8528 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8529 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8530 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8531 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8532 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8534 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8535 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8537 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8538 .cindex "alias for host"
8539 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8540 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8543 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8544 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8545 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8546 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8547 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8550 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8551 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8552 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8553 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8554 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8555 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8556 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8561 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8562 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8563 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8564 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8565 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8567 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8569 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8570 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8571 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8578 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8579 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8580 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8581 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8582 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8583 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8585 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8586 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8588 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8589 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8590 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8591 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8592 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8593 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8594 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8595 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8596 not recognized in an indirected file).
8599 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8600 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8602 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8604 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8605 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8608 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8609 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8612 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8615 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8616 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8617 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8620 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8621 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8624 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8626 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8628 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8629 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8630 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8633 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8634 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8635 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8637 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8639 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8640 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8641 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8642 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8643 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8644 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8645 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8648 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8649 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8651 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8652 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8654 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8655 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8656 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8661 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8663 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8664 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8665 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8666 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8667 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8668 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8669 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8670 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8671 host lists such as whitelists.
8675 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8676 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8677 .cindex "unknown host name"
8678 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8679 If a pattern is of the form
8681 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8685 dbm;/host/accept/list
8687 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8688 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8691 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8692 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8693 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8694 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8695 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8696 lookup, both using the same file.
8700 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8701 If a pattern is of the form
8703 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8705 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8706 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8707 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8709 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8710 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8712 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8713 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8714 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8717 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8718 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8719 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8721 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8722 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8723 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8724 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8725 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8726 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8732 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8733 .cindex "list" "address list"
8734 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8735 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8736 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8737 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8738 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8739 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8740 using this option setting:
8744 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8745 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8746 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8747 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8749 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8752 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8754 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8755 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8756 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8757 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8758 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8759 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8760 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8762 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8763 *@+hostile_domains:\
8764 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8765 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8767 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8768 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8769 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8770 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8771 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8773 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8774 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8775 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8776 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8777 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8779 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8782 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8783 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8787 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8788 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8789 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8790 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8791 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8792 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8793 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8795 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8796 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8798 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8799 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8802 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8803 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8804 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8807 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8808 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8809 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8811 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8812 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8813 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8814 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8816 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8817 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8819 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8820 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8821 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8822 default. For example, with this lookup:
8824 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8826 the file could contains lines like this:
8828 user1@domain1.example
8831 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8834 nimrod@jaeger.example
8838 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8839 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8841 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8843 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8844 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8846 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8847 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8848 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8852 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8853 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8858 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8859 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8860 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8861 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8862 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8863 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8864 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8865 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8866 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8868 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8869 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8870 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8871 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8872 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8875 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8877 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8879 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8881 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8883 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8884 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8885 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8886 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8887 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8888 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8890 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8893 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8896 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8897 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8898 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8899 might have entries like
8901 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8902 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8905 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8906 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8907 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8908 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8910 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8911 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8912 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8915 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8916 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8917 can only return a single list of local parts.
8920 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8921 in these two examples:
8924 senders = *@+my_list
8926 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8927 example it is a named domain list.
8932 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8933 .cindex "case of local parts"
8934 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8935 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8936 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8937 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8938 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8939 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8940 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8941 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8944 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8945 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8946 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8947 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8948 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8949 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8950 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8953 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8954 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8955 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8956 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8957 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8958 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8959 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8960 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8964 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8965 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8966 .cindex "local part" "list"
8967 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8968 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8969 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8970 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8971 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8972 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8973 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8974 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8976 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8977 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8978 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8979 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8980 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8981 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8982 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8984 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8989 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8990 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8992 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8993 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8994 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8995 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8997 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8998 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8999 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9000 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9001 escape character, as described in the following section.
9003 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9004 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9005 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9006 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9007 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9012 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9013 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9014 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9015 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9016 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9017 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9018 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9019 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9021 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9022 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9023 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9024 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9026 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9028 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9029 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9034 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9035 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9036 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9037 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9038 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9039 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9040 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9043 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9044 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9045 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9048 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9049 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9050 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9052 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9053 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9054 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9055 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9056 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9057 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9058 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9061 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9062 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9063 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9066 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9067 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9068 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9069 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9071 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9073 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9074 Exim message identifier. For example:
9076 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9078 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9079 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9082 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9083 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9084 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9085 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9086 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9087 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9088 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9089 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9090 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9091 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9092 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9093 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9099 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9100 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9101 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9102 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9103 white space is significant.
9106 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9107 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9108 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9113 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9114 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9115 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9116 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9117 given, the expansion fails.
9119 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9120 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9121 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9122 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9126 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9127 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9128 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9129 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9130 string easier to understand.
9132 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9133 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9134 expansion item below.
9137 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9138 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9139 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9140 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9141 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9142 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9143 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9144 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9145 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9146 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9147 the result of the expansion.
9148 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9149 the expansion result is an empty string.
9150 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9154 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9155 .cindex authentication "results header"
9156 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9157 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9158 &'Authentication-Results"'&
9160 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9161 will ba a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9162 Methods that may be present in the result include:
9171 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9173 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9178 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9179 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9180 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9181 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9182 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9183 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9184 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9185 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9189 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9190 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9195 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9199 If the field is found,
9200 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9201 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9202 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9203 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9205 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9206 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9209 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9211 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9212 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9214 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9215 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9216 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9217 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9218 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9219 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9220 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9221 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9223 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9224 take an optional modifier of "int"
9225 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9226 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9227 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9229 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9230 newline-separated by default,
9231 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9232 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9233 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9235 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9236 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9237 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9238 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9239 if so the element tags are omitted.
9241 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9243 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9244 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9246 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9247 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9251 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9252 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9253 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9255 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9256 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9257 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9258 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9259 must have the following type:
9261 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9263 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9264 function should return one of the following values:
9266 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9267 into the expanded string that is being built.
9269 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9270 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9272 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9273 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9275 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9277 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9278 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9279 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9282 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9283 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9284 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9285 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9287 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9288 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9289 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9291 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9292 appear, for example:
9294 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9296 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9297 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9299 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9301 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9304 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9305 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9308 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9309 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9310 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9311 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9312 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9313 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9314 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9315 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9317 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9320 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9321 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9322 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9323 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9324 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9325 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9326 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9327 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9328 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9330 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9331 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9332 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9335 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9336 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9338 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9339 appear, for example:
9341 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9343 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9344 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9347 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9348 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9349 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9350 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9351 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9352 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9353 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9354 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9355 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9356 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9357 <&'string3'&> as before.
9359 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9360 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9361 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9362 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9363 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9364 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9365 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9366 provided. For example:
9368 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9372 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9374 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9375 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9378 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9379 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9380 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9382 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9383 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9384 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9385 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9386 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9387 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9388 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9390 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9392 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9393 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9396 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9397 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9398 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9399 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9400 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9401 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9403 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9404 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9405 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9406 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9408 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9410 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9411 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9412 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9413 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9414 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9416 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9418 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9419 letters appear. For example:
9421 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9422 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9423 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9426 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9427 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9428 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9429 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9430 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9431 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9432 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9433 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9434 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9435 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9436 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9437 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9438 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9439 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9443 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9444 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9445 lines) may be present.
9447 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9448 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9451 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9452 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9453 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9456 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9457 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9458 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9459 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9460 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9461 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9462 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9463 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9466 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9467 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9468 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9469 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9470 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9471 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9474 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9475 command of the following form:
9477 headers charset "UTF-8"
9479 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9480 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9481 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9482 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9483 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9486 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9487 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9488 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9489 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9491 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9492 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9493 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9494 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9495 router or transport are not accessible.
9497 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9498 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9499 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9500 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9501 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9502 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9503 point they are added.
9504 When any of the above ACLs ar
9505 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9507 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9508 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9509 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9510 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9511 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9512 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9513 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9516 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9517 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9518 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9519 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9520 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9521 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9522 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9523 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9526 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9527 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9529 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9530 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9531 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9532 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9533 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9534 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9535 present. For example:
9537 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9539 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9542 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9544 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9545 an Exim configuration:
9547 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9549 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9552 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9553 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9554 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9556 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9557 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9558 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9559 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9560 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9561 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9564 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9565 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9566 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9567 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9568 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9569 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9571 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9573 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9574 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9575 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9576 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9577 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9579 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9580 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9581 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9583 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9587 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9592 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9593 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9594 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9595 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9596 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9597 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9601 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9602 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9603 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9604 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9605 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9606 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9607 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9610 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9612 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9613 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9614 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9617 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9618 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9619 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9620 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9621 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9622 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9623 apart from an optional leading minus,
9624 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9626 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9627 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9629 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9630 If the number is negative, the fields are
9631 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9632 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9633 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9635 If the modulus of the
9636 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9637 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9641 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9645 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9647 yields &"result: 42"&.
9649 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9650 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9652 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9655 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9656 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9657 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9658 described in the next item.
9660 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9661 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9662 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9663 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9664 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9665 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9666 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9667 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9668 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9670 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9671 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9672 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9673 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9674 out by the system administrator.
9677 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9678 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9679 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9680 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9681 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9682 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9683 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9684 original lookup fails.
9686 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9687 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9688 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9689 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9690 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9691 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9692 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9693 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9695 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9696 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9697 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9698 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9700 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9701 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9702 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9703 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9705 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9707 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9709 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9710 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9712 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9717 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9718 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9720 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9721 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9722 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9723 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9724 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9725 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9727 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9729 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9730 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9731 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9733 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9734 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9735 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9736 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9737 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9738 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9739 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9741 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9743 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9744 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9745 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9746 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9749 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9751 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9755 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9756 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9757 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9758 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9759 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9760 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9761 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9762 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9764 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9765 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9766 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9767 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9768 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9771 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9772 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9773 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9775 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9776 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9779 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9780 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9781 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9782 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9783 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9784 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9785 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9786 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9788 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9789 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9790 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9791 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9792 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9793 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9794 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9795 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9796 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9797 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9799 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9800 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9801 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9802 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9804 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9805 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9806 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9807 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9808 is the expansion of the third argument.
9810 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9811 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9812 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9814 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9815 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9816 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9817 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9818 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9819 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9820 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9821 newlines are left in the string.
9822 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9823 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9824 the string expansion fails.
9826 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9827 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9831 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9832 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9833 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9834 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9835 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9836 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9837 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9840 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9841 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9843 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9844 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9845 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9846 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9847 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9850 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9852 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9853 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9854 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9855 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9856 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9857 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9858 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9860 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9862 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9863 and must be present if the argument is given.
9864 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9865 One option type is currently recognised, defining whether (the default)
9866 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9867 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9869 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9871 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9872 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9873 turns them into spaces:
9875 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9877 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9878 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9879 addition, the following errors can occur:
9882 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9884 Failure to connect the socket;
9886 Failure to write the request string;
9888 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9891 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9892 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9893 errors occurs. For example:
9895 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9898 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9899 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9900 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9901 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9902 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9904 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9905 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9908 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9909 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9910 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9913 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9914 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9915 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9916 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9917 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9918 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9919 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9920 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9921 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9923 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9925 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9928 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9930 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9931 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9934 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9935 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9936 expansion item above.
9938 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9939 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9940 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9941 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9942 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9943 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9944 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9945 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9946 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9948 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9949 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9950 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9951 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9952 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9953 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9954 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9955 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9956 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9959 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9960 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9961 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9963 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9964 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9965 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9966 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9967 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9970 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9971 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9972 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9973 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9975 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9976 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9977 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9980 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9981 log_message = Output of id: $value
9983 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9984 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9986 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9990 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9991 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9993 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9994 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9998 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9999 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10002 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10003 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10004 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10005 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10007 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10008 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10011 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10012 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10013 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10014 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10015 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10016 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10017 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10018 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10020 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10022 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10023 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10024 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10026 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10028 yields &"defabc"&, and
10030 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10032 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10033 the regular expression from string expansion.
10037 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10038 .cindex sorting "a list"
10039 .cindex list sorting
10040 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10041 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10042 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
10043 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10044 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10045 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10046 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10047 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10048 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10049 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10050 to give values for comparison.
10052 The item result is a sorted list,
10053 with the original list separator,
10054 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10058 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10060 sorts a list of numbers, and
10062 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10064 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10067 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10068 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10069 .cindex "substring extraction"
10070 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10071 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10072 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10073 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10074 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10076 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10078 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10079 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10082 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10083 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10084 length required. For example
10086 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10088 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10089 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10090 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10091 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
10093 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10094 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
10095 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10097 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10099 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10100 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10101 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10103 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10105 yields an empty string, but
10107 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10111 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10112 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
10113 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10114 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10117 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10119 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10123 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10124 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10125 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10126 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10127 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
10128 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10129 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10130 replacement list. For example
10132 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10134 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10135 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10136 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10142 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10143 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10144 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10145 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10146 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10147 following operations can be performed:
10150 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10151 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10152 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10153 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10154 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10155 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10158 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10159 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10160 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10161 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10162 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10163 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10164 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10165 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10166 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10168 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10169 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10170 character. For example:
10172 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10174 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10175 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10176 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10177 separator explicitly:
10179 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10182 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10183 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10184 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10187 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10188 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10189 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10190 email address separator. For the example header line:
10192 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10194 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10195 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10196 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10197 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10198 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10199 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10202 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10203 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10205 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10206 Last:user@example.com
10207 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10211 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10212 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10213 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10214 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10215 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10216 Only lowercase letters are used.
10218 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10219 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10220 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10221 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10222 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10224 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10225 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10226 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10227 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10228 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10229 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10230 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10231 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10232 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10234 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10235 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10236 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10237 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10238 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10239 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10242 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10243 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10244 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10245 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10246 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10247 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10249 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10250 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10253 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10254 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10255 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10256 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10257 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10260 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10261 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10262 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10263 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10264 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10267 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10268 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10269 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10270 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10271 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10272 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10273 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10275 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10276 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10277 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10278 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10279 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10280 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10283 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10284 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10285 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10286 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10287 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10288 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10289 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10290 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10291 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10292 C programming language):
10294 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10295 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10296 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10297 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10298 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10300 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10302 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10303 space is permitted before or after operators.
10305 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10306 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10307 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10308 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10309 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10311 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10313 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10314 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10317 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10318 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10319 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10320 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10321 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10322 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10323 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10324 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10325 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10326 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10327 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10330 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10332 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10335 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10338 {$recipients_count} \
10339 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10343 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10344 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10347 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10348 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10349 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10352 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10354 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10355 and then re-expands what it has found.
10358 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10360 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10361 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10362 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10363 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10364 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10365 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10366 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10367 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10368 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10370 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10371 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10372 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10373 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10374 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10375 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10376 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10379 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10380 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10381 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10382 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10383 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10384 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10386 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10388 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10389 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10393 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10394 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10395 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10396 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10397 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10398 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10402 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10403 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10404 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10405 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10406 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10407 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10408 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10411 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10412 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10413 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10414 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10415 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10416 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10417 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10419 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10420 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10421 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10422 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10423 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10424 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10425 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10426 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10427 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10430 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10431 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10432 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10433 .cindex "lower casing"
10434 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10435 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10436 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10441 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10442 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10443 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10444 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10445 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10446 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10448 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10450 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10451 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10452 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10455 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10456 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10457 .cindex "list" "item count"
10458 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10459 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10460 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10463 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10464 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10465 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10466 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10467 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10468 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10469 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10470 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10471 matching list is returned.
10474 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10475 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10476 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10477 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10478 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10482 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10483 .cindex "masked IP address"
10484 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10485 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10486 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10487 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10488 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10489 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10490 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10491 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10492 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10494 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10496 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10497 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10498 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10499 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10501 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10505 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10507 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10510 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10512 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10513 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10514 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10515 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10516 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10518 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10519 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10522 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10523 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10524 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10525 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10526 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10527 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10529 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10531 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10534 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10535 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10536 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10537 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10538 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10539 is an empty string or
10540 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10541 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10542 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10543 respectively For example,
10551 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10552 variable or a message header.
10554 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10555 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10556 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10557 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10558 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10559 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10560 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10563 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10564 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10565 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10566 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10567 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10569 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10575 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10576 yields an unchanged string.
10579 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10580 .cindex "random number"
10581 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10582 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10583 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10584 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10585 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10586 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10587 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10588 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10592 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10593 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10594 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10595 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10596 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10597 for DNS. For example,
10599 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10600 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10605 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10609 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10610 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10611 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10612 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10613 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10614 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10615 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10616 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10617 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10620 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10622 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10623 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10627 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10628 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10629 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10630 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10631 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10632 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10633 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10634 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10636 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10637 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10638 to use this operator as well.
10642 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10643 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10644 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10645 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10646 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10647 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10648 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10651 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10652 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10653 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10654 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10655 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10656 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10657 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10659 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10660 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10663 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10664 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10665 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10666 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10667 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10668 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10670 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10672 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10673 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10676 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10677 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10678 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10679 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10680 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10681 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10683 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10685 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10686 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10687 with 256 being the default.
10689 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10690 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10692 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10693 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
10697 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10698 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10699 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10700 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10701 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10702 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10703 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10704 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10705 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10706 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10707 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10708 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10709 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10711 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10712 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10713 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10715 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10716 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10717 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10721 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10722 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10723 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10724 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10725 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10726 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10729 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10730 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10731 .cindex "substring extraction"
10732 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10733 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10734 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10735 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10737 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10739 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10740 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10742 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10743 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10744 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10745 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10748 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10749 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10750 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10751 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10752 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10753 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10756 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10757 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10758 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10759 .cindex "upper casing"
10760 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10761 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10762 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10764 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10765 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10766 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10767 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10768 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10769 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10770 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10772 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10773 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10774 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10775 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10776 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10777 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10779 .cindex internationalisation
10780 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10781 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10782 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10783 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10784 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10785 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10793 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10794 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10795 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10796 while expanding strings:
10799 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10800 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10801 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10802 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10805 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10806 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10807 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10808 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10814 &`>= `& greater or equal
10816 &`<= `& less or equal
10820 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10822 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10823 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10824 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10825 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10826 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10829 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10830 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10831 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10834 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10835 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10836 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10837 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10838 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10839 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10840 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10841 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10842 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10843 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10844 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10845 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10846 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10847 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10849 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10850 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10851 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10852 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10853 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10854 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10856 An empty string is treated as false.
10857 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10858 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10859 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10861 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10862 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10865 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10869 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10870 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10871 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10872 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10873 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10874 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10875 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10876 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10878 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10880 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10881 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10882 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10883 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10884 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10885 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10886 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10887 included in the binary.
10889 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10890 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10891 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10892 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10893 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10894 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10895 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10896 string in LDAP form is:
10898 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10900 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10901 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10903 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10905 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10910 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10911 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10912 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10913 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10914 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10915 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10919 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10920 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10921 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10922 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10923 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10924 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10927 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10928 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10929 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10930 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10931 whatever its length.
10934 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10935 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10936 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10937 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10939 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10940 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10941 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10942 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10943 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10944 support &[crypt16()]&.
10946 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10947 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10948 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10949 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10950 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10952 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10953 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10954 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10956 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10957 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10958 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10959 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10960 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10962 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10963 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10964 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10965 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10966 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10967 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10969 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10971 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10972 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10974 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10975 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10976 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10977 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10978 exists in the message. For example,
10980 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10982 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10983 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10985 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10986 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10987 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10988 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10989 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10990 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10991 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10992 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10993 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10995 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10996 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10997 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10998 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10999 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11000 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11001 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11002 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11004 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11005 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11006 .cindex "first delivery"
11007 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11008 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11009 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11010 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11013 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11014 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11015 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11016 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11017 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11019 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11020 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11021 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11022 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11023 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11025 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11026 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11027 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11029 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11030 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11031 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11033 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11034 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11035 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11036 list separator is changed to a comma:
11038 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11040 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11041 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11043 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11046 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11047 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11048 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11049 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11050 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11051 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11052 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11053 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11054 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11057 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11058 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11059 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11060 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11061 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11062 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11063 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11064 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11065 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11068 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11069 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11070 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11071 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11072 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11073 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11076 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11077 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11079 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11080 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11081 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11082 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11085 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11086 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11087 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11088 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11089 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11090 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11091 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11092 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11093 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11094 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11095 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11097 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11098 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11099 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11100 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11101 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11103 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11104 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11106 This is no longer the case.
11108 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11109 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11111 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11113 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11115 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11116 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11117 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11118 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11119 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11120 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11121 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11122 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11123 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11124 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11125 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11126 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11127 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11131 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11132 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11133 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11134 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11135 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11136 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11137 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11138 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11139 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11142 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11143 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11144 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11145 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11146 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11147 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11148 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11149 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11150 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11154 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11155 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11156 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11157 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11158 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11159 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11160 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11161 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11162 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11163 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11164 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11167 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11169 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11170 backslashes is also required.
11172 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11173 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11174 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11175 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11176 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11177 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11179 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11180 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11181 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11182 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11183 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11184 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11185 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11186 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11188 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11189 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11190 See &*match_local_part*&.
11192 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11193 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11194 See &*match_local_part*&.
11196 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11197 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11198 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11199 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11200 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11201 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11203 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11205 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11208 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11210 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11212 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11213 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11214 in a single test such as
11215 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11216 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11217 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11218 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11220 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11222 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11224 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11226 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11227 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11228 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11229 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11230 masks. For example:
11232 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11234 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11235 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11236 address mask, for example:
11238 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11240 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11241 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11243 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11247 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11248 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11250 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11252 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11253 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11254 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11255 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11256 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11257 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11258 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11259 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11262 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11264 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11265 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11266 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11267 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11269 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11271 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11272 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11273 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11274 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11277 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11278 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11280 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11281 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11282 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11283 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11285 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11286 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11287 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11288 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11289 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11290 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11291 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11292 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11293 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11294 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11295 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11299 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11300 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11302 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11303 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11304 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11305 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11306 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11307 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11308 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11310 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11311 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11312 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11313 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11314 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11316 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11318 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11320 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11322 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11323 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11324 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11325 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11326 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11327 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11328 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11329 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11332 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11333 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11335 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11336 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11337 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11338 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11339 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11340 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11342 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11343 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11344 building Exim. For example:
11346 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11348 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11349 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11350 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11351 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11353 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11354 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11355 configuration, you might have this:
11357 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11359 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11361 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11363 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11364 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11365 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11366 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11367 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11368 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11371 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11373 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11374 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11375 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11376 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11377 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11380 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11381 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11382 this library, you need to set
11384 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11386 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11387 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11389 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11391 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11392 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11393 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11395 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11396 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11397 the authentication is successful. For example:
11399 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11403 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11404 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11405 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11407 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11408 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11409 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11410 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11411 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11412 by a process that is not running as root.
11414 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11415 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11416 building Exim. For example:
11418 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11420 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11421 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11422 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11424 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11425 two are mandatory. For example:
11427 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11429 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11430 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11431 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11436 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11437 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11438 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11439 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11440 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11441 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11442 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11446 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11447 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11448 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11449 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11450 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11453 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11455 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11456 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11457 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11459 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11460 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11461 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11462 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11463 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11464 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11465 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11466 parsed but not evaluated.
11468 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11473 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11474 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11475 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11476 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11477 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11480 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11481 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11482 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11483 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11484 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11485 In the expansion condition case
11486 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11487 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11488 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11489 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11490 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11491 matching condition.
11493 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11494 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11495 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11496 any unused variables being made empty.
11498 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11499 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11500 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11501 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11502 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11503 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11504 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11505 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11506 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11507 during subsequent delivery.
11509 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11510 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11511 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11512 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11513 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11514 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11515 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11516 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11519 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11520 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11521 this variable has the number of arguments.
11523 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11524 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11525 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11526 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11527 be preserved by coding like this:
11529 warn !verify = sender
11530 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11532 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11533 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11536 .vitem &$address_data$&
11537 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11538 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11539 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11540 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11541 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11542 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11545 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11546 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11547 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11548 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11549 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11550 from the child's routing.
11552 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11553 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11554 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11557 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11558 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11559 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11561 .vitem &$address_file$&
11562 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11563 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11564 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11565 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11566 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11568 /home/r2d2/savemail
11570 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11571 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11572 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11573 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11574 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11575 to the relevant file.
11577 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11578 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11579 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11580 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11582 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11583 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11584 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11585 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11587 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11588 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11589 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11590 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11591 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11592 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11593 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11594 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11595 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11596 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11597 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11598 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11599 command line option.
11601 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11602 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11603 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11604 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11605 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11606 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11607 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11608 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11609 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11613 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11614 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11615 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11616 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11617 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11618 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11619 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11620 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11621 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11622 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11623 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11625 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11626 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11627 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11628 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11629 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11632 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11633 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11634 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11635 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11636 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11637 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11638 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11639 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11640 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11641 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11642 an undefined mechanism.
11644 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11645 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11646 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11647 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11648 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11649 the ACL malware condition.
11651 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11652 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11653 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11654 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11655 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11656 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11658 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11659 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11660 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11661 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11662 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11663 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11664 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11666 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11667 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11668 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11669 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11670 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11672 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11673 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11674 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11675 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11676 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11678 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11679 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11680 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11681 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11682 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11683 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11684 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11686 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11687 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11688 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11689 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11690 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11691 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11692 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11694 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11695 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11696 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11697 address that was connected to.
11699 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11700 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11701 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11702 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11703 compilations of the same version of the program.
11705 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11706 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11707 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11708 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11709 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11710 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11712 .vitem &$config_file$&
11713 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11714 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11716 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
11717 Results of DKIM verification.
11718 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11720 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11721 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11722 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11723 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11724 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11726 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11727 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11728 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11729 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11730 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11731 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11732 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11733 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11734 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11735 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11736 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11737 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11738 &$dkim_key_length$&
11739 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11740 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11742 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11743 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11744 When a message has been received this variable contains
11745 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11746 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11748 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11749 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11750 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11752 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11753 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11754 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11755 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11756 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11757 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11758 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11759 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11760 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11763 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11764 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11765 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11766 case for &$domain$&.
11768 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11769 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11770 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11771 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11773 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11774 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11775 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11776 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11777 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11778 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11780 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11781 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11782 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11784 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11787 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11788 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11789 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11790 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11791 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11792 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11793 the &(smtp)& transport.
11796 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11797 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11798 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11799 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11802 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11803 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11804 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11805 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11806 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11807 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11810 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11811 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11812 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11813 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11817 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11818 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11819 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11820 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11821 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11822 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11823 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11826 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11827 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11828 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11831 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11832 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11833 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11835 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11836 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11837 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11839 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11840 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11841 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11843 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11844 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11845 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11846 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11847 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11848 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11850 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11851 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11852 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11853 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11854 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11856 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11857 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11858 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11859 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11860 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11864 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11865 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11866 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11867 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11868 by a setting on the transport itself.
11870 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11871 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11872 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11876 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11877 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11878 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11879 to local and remote transports.
11881 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11882 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11883 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11884 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11885 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11886 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11887 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11890 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11891 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11892 client is connected.
11895 .vitem &$host_address$&
11896 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11897 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11898 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11899 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11901 .vitem &$host_data$&
11902 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11903 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11904 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11905 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11907 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11908 message = $host_data
11910 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11911 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11912 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11913 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11914 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11915 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11916 variables is set to &"1"&.
11919 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11920 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11923 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11924 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11925 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11928 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11929 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11930 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11931 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11932 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11933 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11934 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11935 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11936 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11937 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11939 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11940 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11941 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11943 .vitem &$host_port$&
11944 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11945 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11946 for an outbound connection.
11948 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
11949 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
11950 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
11951 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
11952 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
11953 to &$spool_directory$& later.
11956 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11957 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11958 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11959 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11960 a unique name for the file.
11962 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11963 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11964 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11966 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11967 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11968 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11972 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11973 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11974 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11978 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11979 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11980 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11983 .vitem &$load_average$&
11984 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11985 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11986 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11987 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11989 .vitem &$local_part$&
11990 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11991 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11992 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11993 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11994 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11996 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11997 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11998 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11999 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12002 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12003 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12004 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12005 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12006 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12007 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12009 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12010 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12011 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
12014 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12015 local part of the recipient address.
12017 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12018 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12019 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12021 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12024 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12025 abc\:xyz@test.example
12027 the value of &$local_part$& is
12031 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12032 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12035 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12037 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12038 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12039 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12041 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12042 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12043 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12044 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12045 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12046 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12047 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12049 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12050 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12051 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12052 variable expands to nothing.
12054 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12055 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12056 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12057 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12058 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12060 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12061 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12062 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12063 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12064 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12066 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12067 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12068 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12069 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12071 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12072 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12073 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12075 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12076 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12077 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12078 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12079 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12080 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12081 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12082 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12084 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12085 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12086 This contains the expanded value of the
12087 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12090 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12091 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12092 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12093 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12094 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12095 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12097 .vitem &$log_space$&
12098 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12099 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12100 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12101 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12102 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12103 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12106 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12107 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12108 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12109 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12110 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12111 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12112 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12113 and &"yes"& if it was.
12114 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12115 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12116 as authenticated data.
12118 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12119 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12120 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12121 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12122 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12123 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12124 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12127 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12128 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12129 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12130 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12131 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12133 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12134 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12135 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12136 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12137 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12138 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12140 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12142 .vitem &$message_age$&
12143 .cindex "message" "age of"
12144 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12145 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12146 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12149 .vitem &$message_body$&
12150 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12151 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12152 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12153 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12154 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12155 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12156 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12157 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12158 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12160 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12161 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12162 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12163 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12164 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12166 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12167 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12168 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12169 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12170 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12171 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12174 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12175 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12176 .cindex "message body" "size"
12177 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12178 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12179 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12180 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12181 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12183 If the spool file is wireformat
12184 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12185 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12187 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12188 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12189 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12190 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12191 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12192 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12193 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12194 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12196 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12197 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12198 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12199 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12200 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12201 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12203 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12204 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12205 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12206 contents of header lines is done.
12208 .vitem &$message_id$&
12209 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12211 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12212 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12213 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12214 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12215 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12216 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12217 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12218 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12219 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12220 from the body is not counted.
12222 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12223 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12224 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12225 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12226 header and the body).
12228 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12230 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12232 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12234 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12235 message has not yet been received.
12237 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12239 .vitem &$message_size$&
12240 .cindex "size" "of message"
12241 .cindex "message" "size"
12242 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12243 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12244 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12245 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12246 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12247 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12248 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12249 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12250 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12252 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12253 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12254 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12255 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12257 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12258 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12259 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12260 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12262 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12263 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12264 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12266 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12267 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12268 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12269 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12270 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12271 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12272 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12273 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12274 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12275 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12277 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12278 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12279 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12281 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12282 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12283 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12284 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12285 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12286 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12287 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12288 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12289 the original address.
12291 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12292 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12293 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12294 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12295 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12297 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12298 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12299 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12301 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12302 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12303 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12304 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12305 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12306 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12307 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12308 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12309 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12311 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12312 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12313 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12314 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12315 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12316 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12317 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12318 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12321 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12322 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12323 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12324 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12326 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12327 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12328 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12329 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12332 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12334 This variable contains the current process id.
12336 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12337 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12338 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12339 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12340 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12341 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12342 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12343 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12344 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12345 variable"& error if encountered.
12347 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12348 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12349 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12350 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12351 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12352 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12353 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12356 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12357 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12358 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12359 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12361 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12363 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12365 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12366 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12367 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12368 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12370 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12371 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12372 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12373 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12375 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12376 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12377 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12378 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12380 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12381 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12382 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12383 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12385 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12386 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12387 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12389 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12390 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12391 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12392 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12394 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12395 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12396 .cindex "named queues"
12397 .cindex queues named
12398 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12400 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12401 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12402 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12403 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12404 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12406 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12407 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12408 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12409 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12410 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12411 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12413 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12414 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12415 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12416 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12417 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12419 .vitem &$received_count$&
12420 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12421 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12422 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12423 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12426 .vitem &$received_for$&
12427 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12428 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12429 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12430 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12431 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12433 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12434 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12435 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12436 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12437 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12438 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12439 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12442 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12443 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12444 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12445 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12446 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12448 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12450 .vitem &$received_port$&
12451 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12452 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12454 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12455 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12456 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12457 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12458 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12459 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12460 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12461 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12462 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12464 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12465 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12466 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12467 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12468 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12469 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12471 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12472 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12473 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12475 .vitem &$received_time$&
12476 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12477 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12478 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12480 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12481 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12482 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12483 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12484 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12486 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12487 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12489 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12490 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12491 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12492 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12494 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12495 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12496 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12497 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12500 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12501 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12504 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12507 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12508 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12512 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12515 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12518 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12519 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12521 .vitem &$recipients$&
12522 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12523 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12524 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12525 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12526 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12530 In a system filter file.
12532 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12533 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12534 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12535 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12537 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12541 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12542 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12543 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12544 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12545 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12546 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12549 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12550 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12551 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12552 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12554 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12555 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12556 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12557 these variables contain the
12558 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12561 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12562 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12563 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12564 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12565 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12566 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12567 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12569 .vitem &$return_path$&
12570 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12571 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12572 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12573 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12574 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12575 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12576 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12577 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12578 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12579 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12582 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12583 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12584 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12586 .vitem &$router_name$&
12587 .cindex "router" "name"
12588 .cindex "name" "of router"
12589 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12590 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12593 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12594 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12595 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12596 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12597 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12598 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12599 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12602 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12603 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12604 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12605 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12606 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12607 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12608 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12609 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12611 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12612 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12613 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12614 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12615 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12616 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12618 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12619 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12620 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12621 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12622 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12623 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12624 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12625 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12627 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12628 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12629 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12631 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12632 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12633 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12635 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12636 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12637 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12638 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12639 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12642 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12643 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12645 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12646 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12647 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12648 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12650 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12651 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12652 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12653 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12654 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12655 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12656 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12657 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12658 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12659 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12660 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12661 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12662 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12664 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12665 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12666 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12667 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12668 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12670 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12671 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12672 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12673 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12674 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12675 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12677 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12678 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12679 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12680 this variable contains that
12681 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12683 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12684 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12685 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12686 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12687 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12688 &$authenticated_id$&.
12690 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12691 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12692 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12693 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12694 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12695 resolver library states that both
12696 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12697 other times, this variable is false.
12699 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12700 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12701 library, by setting:
12706 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12707 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12709 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12710 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12712 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12713 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12714 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12715 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12718 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12719 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12720 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12721 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12722 other means, this variable is empty.
12724 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12725 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12726 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12727 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12728 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12729 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12730 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12732 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12733 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12734 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12735 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12737 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12738 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12739 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12742 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12743 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12744 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12745 following are true:
12748 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12750 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12751 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12752 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12754 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12755 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12756 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12758 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12759 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12760 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12762 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12763 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12764 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12765 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12767 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12769 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12770 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12774 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12775 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12776 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12777 number that was used on the remote host.
12779 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12780 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12781 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12782 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12783 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12786 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12787 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12788 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12789 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12791 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12792 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12793 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12794 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12795 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12796 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12797 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12798 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12799 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12800 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12801 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12804 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12805 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12806 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12807 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12808 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12810 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12811 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12812 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12813 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12814 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12816 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12817 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12818 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12819 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12820 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12821 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12822 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12824 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12825 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12826 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12827 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12828 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12830 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12831 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12832 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12833 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12834 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12835 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12837 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12838 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12839 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12840 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12841 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12846 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12847 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12848 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12849 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12851 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12852 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12853 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12854 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12855 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12856 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12857 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12859 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
12860 .cindex SMTP "command history"
12861 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
12862 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
12863 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
12866 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12867 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12868 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12869 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12870 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12871 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12872 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12873 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12874 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12875 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12876 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12878 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12879 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12880 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12881 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12882 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12883 message is junk mail.
12885 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12886 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12887 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12888 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12891 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
12892 &$spf_received$& &&&
12894 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
12895 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
12896 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
12899 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12900 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12901 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12903 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12904 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12905 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12906 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12907 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12908 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12910 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12911 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12912 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12913 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12914 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12915 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12916 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12917 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12919 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12921 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12924 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12925 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12926 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12927 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12928 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12929 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12931 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12932 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12933 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12934 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12935 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12936 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12937 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12938 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12940 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12941 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12944 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12945 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12946 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12947 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12948 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12949 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12951 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12952 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12953 .cindex certificate variables
12954 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12955 inbound connection when the message was received.
12956 It is only useful as the argument of a
12957 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12958 or a &%def%& condition.
12960 &*Note*&: Under current versions of OpenSSL, when a list of more than one
12961 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
12963 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12964 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12965 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12966 inbound connection when the message was received.
12967 It is only useful as the argument of a
12968 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12969 or a &%def%& condition.
12970 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12971 which is not the leaf.
12973 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12974 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12975 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12976 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12977 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12978 or a &%def%& condition.
12980 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12981 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12982 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12983 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12984 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12985 or a &%def%& condition.
12986 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12987 which is not the leaf.
12989 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12990 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12991 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12992 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12994 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12995 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12998 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12999 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13000 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13001 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13002 and &"0"& otherwise.
13004 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13005 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13006 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13007 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13008 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13009 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13010 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13011 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13012 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13014 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13015 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13016 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13018 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13019 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13021 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13022 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13023 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13024 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13026 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13027 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13028 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13030 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13031 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13032 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13033 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13035 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13036 1 No response to request
13037 2 Response not verified
13038 3 Verification failed
13039 4 Verification succeeded
13042 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13043 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13044 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13045 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13046 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13048 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13049 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13050 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13051 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13052 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13053 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13054 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13055 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13056 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13057 which is not the leaf.
13059 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13060 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13063 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13064 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13065 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13066 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13067 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13068 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13069 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13070 which is not the leaf.
13072 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13073 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13074 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13075 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13076 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13077 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13078 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13079 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13080 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13081 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13082 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13084 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13085 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13088 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13089 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13090 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13092 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13095 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13096 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13097 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13099 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13100 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13101 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13102 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13104 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13105 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13106 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13108 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13109 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13110 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13112 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13113 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13114 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13115 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13116 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13117 values for those that are behind (west).
13120 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13121 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13122 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13124 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13125 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13126 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13127 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13130 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13131 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13132 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13135 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13136 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13137 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13138 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13140 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13141 .cindex "transport" "name"
13142 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13143 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13144 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13147 .vindex "&$value$&"
13148 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13149 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13150 &*reduce*& expansion.
13152 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13153 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13154 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13155 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13158 .vitem &$version_number$&
13159 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13160 The version number of Exim.
13162 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13163 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13164 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13165 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13167 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13168 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13169 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13170 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13176 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13177 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13179 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13180 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13181 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13182 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13183 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13184 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13189 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13192 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13193 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13194 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13195 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13196 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13197 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13198 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13199 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13200 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13202 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13203 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13204 should usually be something like
13206 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13208 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13209 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13210 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13211 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13212 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13213 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13214 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13215 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13219 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13220 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13221 a startup when Exim is entered.
13223 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13224 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13227 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13228 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13231 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13232 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13233 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13234 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13235 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13236 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13240 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13241 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13242 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13243 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13247 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13248 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13250 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13251 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13252 with an error message of the form
13254 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13256 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13257 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13258 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13259 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13260 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13261 that was passed to &%die%&.
13264 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13265 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13266 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13269 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13271 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13272 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13273 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13275 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13276 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13277 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13278 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13280 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13281 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13282 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13283 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13284 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13285 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13286 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13289 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13290 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13291 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13292 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13293 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13294 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13295 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13296 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13297 avoided, but the output is lost.
13299 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13300 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13301 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13302 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13303 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13304 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13305 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13307 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13309 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13310 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13311 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13312 as the first subroutine argument.
13316 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13317 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13319 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13320 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13321 "Starting the daemon"
13322 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13323 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13324 .cindex "network interface"
13325 .cindex "interface" "network"
13326 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13327 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13328 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13329 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13330 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13331 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13332 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13333 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13334 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13335 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13336 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13339 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13340 and ports to listen on.
13342 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13343 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13344 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13345 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13346 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13347 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13348 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13349 as an error situation.
13351 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13352 for the outgoing connection.
13356 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13357 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13358 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13359 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13360 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13362 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13363 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13364 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13365 chapter describes how they operate.
13367 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13368 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13372 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13373 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13374 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13378 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13380 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13382 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13383 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13386 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13387 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13388 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13389 colons. For example:
13391 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13394 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13396 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13397 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13400 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13401 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13403 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13404 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13407 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13408 with a colon separator, for example:
13410 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13411 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13415 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13416 default setting contains just one port:
13418 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13420 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13421 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13422 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13423 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13424 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13428 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13429 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13430 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13431 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13432 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13433 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13435 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13437 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13439 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13441 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13445 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13446 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13447 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13448 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13449 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13450 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13453 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13454 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13455 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13456 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13457 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13458 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13462 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13465 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13467 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13468 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13469 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13473 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13474 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13475 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13476 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13477 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13478 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13479 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13480 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13481 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13482 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13483 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13484 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13485 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13488 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13489 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13490 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13492 The common use of this option is expected to be
13494 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13497 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13498 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13500 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13501 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13502 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13503 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13504 connections via the daemon.)
13509 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13510 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13511 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13512 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13513 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13514 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13515 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13516 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13518 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13520 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13521 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13522 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13523 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13524 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13525 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13527 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13529 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13530 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13531 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13532 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13533 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13535 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13536 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13537 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13538 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13539 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13540 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13541 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13542 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13543 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13544 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13545 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13546 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13548 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13549 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13550 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13551 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13552 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13556 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13557 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13559 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13560 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13562 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13563 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13564 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13565 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13567 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13569 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13571 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13573 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13574 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13576 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13577 IPv4 loopback address only:
13579 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13581 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13583 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13585 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13589 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13590 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13591 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13592 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13595 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13596 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13597 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13598 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13600 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13601 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13602 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13603 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13604 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13605 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13606 used for listening. Consider this example:
13608 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13610 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13612 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13614 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13615 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13618 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13619 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13620 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13621 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13622 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13623 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13624 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13625 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13629 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13630 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13631 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13632 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13633 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13634 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13640 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13641 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13643 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13644 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13645 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13646 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13649 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13650 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13652 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13653 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13654 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13656 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13657 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13658 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13659 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13663 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13664 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13665 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13666 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13667 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13668 listed in more than one group.
13670 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13672 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13673 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13674 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13675 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13676 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13677 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13678 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13679 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13680 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13681 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13682 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13686 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13688 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13689 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13690 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13691 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13692 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13693 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13698 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13700 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13701 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
13702 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13703 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13704 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13705 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13706 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13707 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13708 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13709 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13710 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13711 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13716 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13718 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13719 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13720 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13721 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13722 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13723 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13724 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13725 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13726 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13727 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13728 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13729 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13730 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13731 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13732 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13737 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13739 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13740 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13741 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13742 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13747 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13749 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13750 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13751 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13752 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13753 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13754 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13755 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13756 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13757 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13758 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13759 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13760 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13761 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13762 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13763 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13768 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13770 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13771 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13776 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13778 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13779 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13780 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13785 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13787 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13788 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13789 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13790 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13791 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13792 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13793 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13798 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13800 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13801 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13802 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13803 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13804 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13805 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13806 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13807 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13808 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13809 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13810 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13811 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13812 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13813 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13814 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13815 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13817 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13818 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13819 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13820 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13821 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13826 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13828 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13829 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13830 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13831 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13832 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13833 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13834 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13835 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13836 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13837 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13838 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13839 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13840 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13841 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13842 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13843 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13844 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13845 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13846 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13847 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13848 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13849 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13851 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13852 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13853 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13854 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13855 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13856 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13857 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13858 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13859 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13860 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13861 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13862 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13863 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13864 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13865 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13866 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13867 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13868 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13869 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13874 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13876 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13878 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13880 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13881 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13882 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13887 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13889 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13890 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13891 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13892 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13893 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13894 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13895 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13896 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13897 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13898 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13899 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13900 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13901 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13902 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13903 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13904 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13905 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13910 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13912 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13913 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13914 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13915 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13916 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13917 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13918 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13919 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13924 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13926 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13927 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13928 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13929 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13930 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13931 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13932 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13933 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13939 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13941 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13948 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13949 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13952 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13953 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13954 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13955 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13956 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13957 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13958 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13959 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13960 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13961 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13962 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13963 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13964 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13965 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13966 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13968 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13969 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13970 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13971 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13972 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13973 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13974 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13975 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13976 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13977 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13978 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13979 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13980 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13981 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13982 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13983 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13988 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13990 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13991 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13992 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
13993 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13994 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13995 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13996 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13997 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13998 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
13999 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14004 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14006 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14007 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14008 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14009 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14011 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14012 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14013 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14014 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14015 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14016 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14017 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14018 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14019 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14020 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14025 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14027 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14028 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14030 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14031 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14032 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14033 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14034 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14039 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14041 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14042 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14043 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14044 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14045 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14046 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14047 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14048 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14049 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14050 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14051 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14052 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14053 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14054 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14055 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14056 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14057 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14058 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14059 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14060 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14061 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14062 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14063 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14064 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14069 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14071 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14072 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14073 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14074 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14075 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14076 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14077 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14078 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14079 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14080 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14081 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14082 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14083 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14084 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14085 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14090 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14091 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14094 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14096 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14097 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14098 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14099 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14100 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14101 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14102 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14104 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14105 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14106 It now defaults to true.
14107 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14109 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14112 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14114 log_selector = +8bitmime
14117 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14118 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14119 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14120 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14121 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14124 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14125 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14126 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14129 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14130 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14131 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14132 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14133 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14135 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14136 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14137 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14138 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14139 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14141 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14142 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14143 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14144 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14146 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14147 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14148 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14149 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14150 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14152 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14153 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14154 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14155 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14156 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14157 This option defines the ACL that,
14158 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14159 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14160 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14161 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14163 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14164 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14165 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14166 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14167 of a received message.
14168 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14170 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14171 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14172 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14173 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14175 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14176 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14177 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14178 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14180 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14181 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14182 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14183 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14184 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14187 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14188 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14189 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14190 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14192 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14193 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14194 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14195 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14196 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14198 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14199 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14200 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14201 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14202 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14204 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14205 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14206 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14207 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14208 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14210 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14211 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14212 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14215 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14216 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14217 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14218 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14220 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14221 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14222 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14223 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14225 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14226 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14227 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14228 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14230 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14231 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14232 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14233 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14235 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14236 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14237 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14238 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14239 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14241 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14242 .cindex "admin user"
14243 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14244 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14245 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14246 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14247 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14248 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14249 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14251 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14252 .cindex "domain literal"
14253 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14254 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14255 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14256 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14258 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14259 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14260 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14261 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14262 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14263 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14264 the local host's IP addresses.
14267 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14268 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14269 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14270 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14271 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14272 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14273 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14274 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14275 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14277 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14278 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14279 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14280 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14281 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14282 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14283 experiment if they wish.
14285 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14286 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14287 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14288 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14289 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14290 suitable setting is:
14292 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14293 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14295 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14297 dns_check_names_pattern =
14299 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14302 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14303 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14304 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14305 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14306 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14307 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14308 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14309 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14310 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14311 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14312 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14314 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14315 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14316 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14317 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14318 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14319 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14321 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14322 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14323 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14324 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14326 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14328 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14329 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14330 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14331 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14334 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14335 .cindex "thawing messages"
14336 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14337 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14338 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14339 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14340 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14341 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14343 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14344 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14345 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14348 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14349 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14350 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14352 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14354 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14355 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14358 .option bi_command main string unset
14360 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14361 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14362 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14363 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14366 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14367 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14368 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14369 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14370 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14371 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14374 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14375 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14376 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14377 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14379 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14380 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14381 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14382 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14383 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14384 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14385 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14386 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14387 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14388 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14390 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14391 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14392 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14393 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14394 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14395 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14396 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14397 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14398 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14399 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14401 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14402 during reception of a message.
14403 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14405 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14408 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14409 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14410 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14411 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14414 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14415 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14416 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14417 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14418 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14419 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14420 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14421 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14422 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14424 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14425 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14426 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14427 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14428 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14431 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14432 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14433 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14434 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14435 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14436 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14437 connection. A typical setting might be:
14439 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14441 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14443 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14445 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14448 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14449 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14450 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14451 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14452 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14453 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14456 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14457 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14458 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14459 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14462 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14463 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14464 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14465 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14468 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14469 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14470 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14471 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14474 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14475 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14476 callout verification. The default value is
14478 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14480 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14483 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14484 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14487 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14488 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14490 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14491 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14492 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14493 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14494 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14495 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14496 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14497 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14498 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14499 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14502 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14503 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14506 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14507 .cindex "checking disk space"
14508 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14509 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14510 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14511 message is accepted.
14513 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14514 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14515 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14516 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14517 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14518 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14519 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14520 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14523 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14524 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14526 check_spool_space = 100M
14527 check_spool_inodes = 100
14529 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14530 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14533 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14534 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14535 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14537 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14538 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14539 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14540 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14541 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14542 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14544 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14545 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14546 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14548 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14549 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14550 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14552 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14553 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14554 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14555 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14557 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14558 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14559 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14560 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14562 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14564 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14565 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14566 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14567 administrative user.
14568 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14570 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14571 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14572 .cindex memory debugging
14573 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14574 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14575 it should normally be left as default.
14577 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14578 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14579 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14580 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14581 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14582 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14584 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14585 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14586 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14587 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14588 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14589 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14590 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14592 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14593 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14595 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14596 .cindex "warning of delay"
14597 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14598 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14599 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14600 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14601 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14602 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14603 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14604 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14607 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14609 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14610 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14611 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14612 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14616 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14617 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14619 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14621 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14622 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14623 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14625 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14626 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14627 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14628 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14629 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14630 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14631 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14632 not sent. The default is:
14634 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14635 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14636 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14637 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14640 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14641 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14642 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14643 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14645 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14646 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14647 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14648 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14649 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14650 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14651 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14652 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14654 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14655 .cindex "load average"
14656 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14657 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14658 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14659 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14660 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14663 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14664 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14665 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14666 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14667 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14668 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14669 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14670 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14672 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14673 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14674 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14675 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14676 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14677 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14678 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14679 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14681 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14682 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14683 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14684 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14687 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14688 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14689 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14690 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14691 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14692 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14693 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14696 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14697 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14698 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14699 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14700 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14701 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
14704 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14705 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14706 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14707 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14708 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14709 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14710 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14711 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14712 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14713 by a setting such as this:
14715 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14717 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14718 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14719 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14720 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14721 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14722 options are applied after this global option.
14724 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14725 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14726 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14727 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14728 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14729 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14730 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14731 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14732 value of this option. The default pattern is
14734 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14735 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14737 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14738 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14739 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14740 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14741 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14744 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14745 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14746 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14748 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14749 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14750 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14751 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14754 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14755 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14756 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14757 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14758 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14759 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14761 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14764 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14765 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14766 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14767 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
14768 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14769 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14770 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14771 domain matches this list.
14773 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14774 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14775 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14778 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14779 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14780 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14781 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14782 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14783 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14784 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14785 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14786 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14787 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14788 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14789 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14791 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14794 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14795 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14798 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14799 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14800 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14801 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14802 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14803 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14804 match with this expanded domain list.
14806 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14807 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14808 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14809 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14810 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14811 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14813 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14814 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14815 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14817 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14818 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14819 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14820 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14821 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14823 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14824 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14825 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14826 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14827 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14828 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14829 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14830 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14833 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14835 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
14836 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
14837 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
14840 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14841 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14842 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14843 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14845 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14846 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14847 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14848 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14849 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14850 and accepted from, these hosts.
14851 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14852 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14853 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14854 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14857 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14858 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14859 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14860 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14861 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14862 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14864 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14866 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14867 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14869 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14870 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14871 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14872 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14873 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14874 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14875 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14876 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14877 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14880 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14881 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14882 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14883 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14884 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14885 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14886 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14887 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14888 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14890 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14891 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14892 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14893 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14894 are examined. For example:
14896 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14897 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14898 postmaster@mydomain.example
14900 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14901 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14902 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14903 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14904 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14905 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14906 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14909 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14910 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14911 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14913 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14915 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14916 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14917 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14918 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14919 overrides the default.
14921 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14922 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14923 and warning messages. For example:
14925 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14927 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14928 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14929 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14930 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14934 .option event_action main string&!! unset
14936 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14937 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14940 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14941 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14942 .cindex "Exim group"
14943 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14944 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14945 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14946 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14947 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14951 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14952 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14953 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14954 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14955 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14956 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14958 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14959 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14960 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14961 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14964 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14965 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14966 .cindex "Exim user"
14967 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14968 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14969 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14970 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14972 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14973 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14974 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14975 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14978 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14979 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14980 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14981 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14984 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14985 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14987 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14988 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14990 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14991 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14992 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14993 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14994 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14995 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14996 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14997 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14998 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14999 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15003 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15004 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15005 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15006 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15007 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15008 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15009 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15010 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15013 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15014 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15015 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15016 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15020 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15021 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15022 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15023 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15024 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15025 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15026 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15027 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15028 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15029 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15030 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15031 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15032 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15033 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15034 logging that you require.
15037 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15039 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15040 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15041 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15042 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15043 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15044 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15045 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15046 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15048 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15049 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15050 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15053 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15054 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15055 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15056 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15058 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15062 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15063 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15066 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15067 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15068 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15069 implementations of TLS.
15072 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15073 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15074 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15077 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15082 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15083 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15084 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15085 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15086 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15087 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15091 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15092 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15093 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15094 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15095 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15096 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15097 sections are rejected.
15100 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15101 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15102 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15103 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15104 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15105 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15106 zero means &"no limit"&.
15111 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15112 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15113 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15114 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15115 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15116 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15117 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15118 if you want to do semantic checking.
15119 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15123 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15124 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15125 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15126 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15127 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15128 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15129 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15131 helo_allow_chars = _
15133 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15136 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15137 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15138 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15139 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15140 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15141 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15142 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15146 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15147 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15148 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15149 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15150 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15151 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15152 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15153 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15154 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15155 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15156 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15157 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15159 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15160 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15161 EHLO command either:
15164 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15166 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15167 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15168 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15169 calling host address, or
15171 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15174 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15175 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15176 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15178 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15179 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15180 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15182 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15183 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15184 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15185 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15186 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15187 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15188 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15189 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15190 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15193 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15194 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15195 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15196 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15197 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15198 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15199 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15200 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15201 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15203 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15204 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15205 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15206 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15207 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15209 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15210 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15211 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15212 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15215 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15216 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15217 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15218 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15219 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15220 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15221 default configuration file contains
15225 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15226 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15228 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15229 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15230 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15232 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15233 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15234 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15235 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15236 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15237 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15240 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15241 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15242 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15243 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15244 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15247 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15248 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15249 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15250 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15254 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15255 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15256 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15257 as soon as the connection is made.
15258 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15259 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15260 connections immediately.
15262 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15263 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15264 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15265 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15266 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15269 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15270 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15271 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15272 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15273 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15274 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15275 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15276 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15277 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15279 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15281 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15285 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15286 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15287 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15288 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15291 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15292 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15293 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15294 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15295 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15297 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15298 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15300 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15301 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15302 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15303 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15304 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15305 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15306 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15309 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15310 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15311 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15312 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15313 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15317 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15318 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15319 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15320 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15321 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15322 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15324 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15325 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15326 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15327 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15328 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15329 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15330 for frozen messages. For example,
15332 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15334 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15335 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15336 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15337 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15338 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15339 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15342 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15343 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15344 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15345 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15346 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15347 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15348 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15349 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15350 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15351 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15354 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15355 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15357 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15358 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15359 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15360 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15361 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15362 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15363 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15364 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15365 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15367 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15368 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15370 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15371 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15372 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15373 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15375 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15376 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15377 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15380 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15381 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15382 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15386 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15387 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15388 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15389 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15393 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15394 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15395 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15396 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15397 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15398 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15399 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15400 and constrained to be a directory.
15403 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15404 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15405 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15406 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15407 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15408 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15409 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15410 and constrained to be a file.
15413 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15414 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15415 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15416 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15417 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15418 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15421 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15422 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15423 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15424 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15425 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15426 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15427 identity to be proven.
15430 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15431 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15432 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15433 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15434 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15437 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15438 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15439 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15440 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15441 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15445 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15446 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15447 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15448 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15449 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15450 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15454 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15455 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15456 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15457 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15458 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15460 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15461 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15462 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15465 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15466 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15467 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15468 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15469 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15470 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15471 has been built with LDAP support.
15475 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15476 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15477 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15478 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15479 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15480 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15481 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15483 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15484 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15485 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15487 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15488 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15489 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15490 and the default qualify domain.
15492 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15493 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15494 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15495 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15497 .cindex "envelope sender"
15498 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15499 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15500 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15502 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15503 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15504 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15509 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15510 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15511 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15512 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15513 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15514 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15515 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15518 local_from_prefix = *-
15520 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15522 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15524 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15525 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15529 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15530 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15533 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15534 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15535 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15536 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15537 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15538 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15539 &%local_interfaces%& is
15541 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15543 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15545 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15548 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15549 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15550 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15551 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15552 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15553 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15554 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15555 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15559 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15560 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15561 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15562 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15563 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15564 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15565 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15566 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15571 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15572 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15573 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15574 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15575 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15576 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15577 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15578 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15579 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15580 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15581 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15582 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15583 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15584 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15585 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15589 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15590 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15591 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15592 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15593 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15594 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15595 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15596 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15597 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15598 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15599 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15600 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15601 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15602 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15603 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15606 .option log_selector main string unset
15607 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15608 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15609 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15610 minus characters. For example:
15612 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15614 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15615 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15618 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15619 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15620 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15621 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15622 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15623 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15624 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15625 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15626 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15627 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15628 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15629 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15630 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15633 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15634 .cindex "too many open files"
15635 .cindex "open files, too many"
15636 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15637 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15638 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15639 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15640 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15641 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15642 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15643 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15644 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15645 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15646 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15647 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15650 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15651 .cindex "length of login name"
15652 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15653 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15654 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15655 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15656 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15657 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15660 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15661 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15662 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15663 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15664 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15665 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15666 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15667 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15670 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15671 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15672 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15673 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15674 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15675 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15676 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15679 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15680 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15681 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15682 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15683 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15684 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15685 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15686 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15687 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15688 empty string, the option is ignored.
15691 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15692 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15693 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15694 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15695 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15696 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15697 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15698 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15699 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15700 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15701 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15702 colons will become hyphens.
15705 .option message_logs main boolean true
15706 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15707 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15708 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15709 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15710 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15711 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15712 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15713 which is not affected by this option.
15716 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15717 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15718 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15719 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15720 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15721 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15722 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15723 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15724 optionally followed by K or M.
15726 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15727 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15728 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15729 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15730 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15732 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15733 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15734 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15735 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15736 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15737 message that an individual transport can process.
15739 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15740 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15741 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15742 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15743 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15744 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15745 some problems may result.
15747 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15748 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15749 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15752 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15753 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15754 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15756 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15758 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15759 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15760 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15761 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15762 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15765 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15766 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15767 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15768 contains a full description of this facility.
15772 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15773 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15774 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15775 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15776 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15779 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15780 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15781 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15782 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15783 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15786 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15787 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15788 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15789 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15790 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15792 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15793 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15796 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15798 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15799 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15803 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15804 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15805 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15806 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15807 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15809 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15810 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15811 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15812 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15813 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15814 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15815 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15817 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15818 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15819 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15820 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15821 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15823 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15825 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15826 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15827 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15828 some now infamous attacks.
15832 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15833 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15834 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15836 # Disable older protocol versions:
15837 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15840 Possible options may include:
15844 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15846 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15848 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15852 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15854 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15856 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15858 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15860 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15862 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15866 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15880 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15884 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15886 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15888 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15890 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15894 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15897 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15898 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15899 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15900 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15901 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15902 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15905 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15906 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15907 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15908 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15909 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15912 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15913 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15914 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15915 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15916 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15917 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15918 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15919 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15920 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15921 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15924 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15925 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15926 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15927 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15928 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15929 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15930 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15933 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15935 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15936 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15939 .option perl_startup main string unset
15941 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15942 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15944 .option perl_startup main boolean false
15946 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
15949 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15950 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15951 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15952 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15953 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15954 PostgreSQL support.
15957 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15958 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15959 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15960 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15961 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15964 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15966 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15968 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15969 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15970 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15973 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15974 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15975 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15976 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15977 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15978 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15979 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15980 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15981 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15984 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15985 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15986 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15987 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15988 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15989 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15990 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15991 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15993 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15994 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15995 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15996 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15997 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15998 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15999 volume of mail. Use with care!
16002 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16003 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16004 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16005 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16006 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16007 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16008 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16009 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16010 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16011 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16013 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16014 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16015 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16016 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16017 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16018 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16021 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16022 .cindex "printing characters"
16023 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16024 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16025 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16026 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16027 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16028 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16031 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16032 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16033 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16034 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16035 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16039 .option process_log_path main string unset
16040 .cindex "process log path"
16041 .cindex "log" "process log"
16042 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16043 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16044 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16045 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16046 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16047 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16048 different spool directories.
16051 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16052 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16056 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16057 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16058 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16061 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16062 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16063 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16064 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16065 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16066 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16067 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16068 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16069 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16071 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16072 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16073 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16074 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16075 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16076 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16077 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16080 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16081 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16082 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16086 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16087 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16088 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16089 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16090 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16091 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16092 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16093 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16096 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16097 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16099 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16100 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16101 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16102 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16105 .option queue_only main boolean false
16106 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16107 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16108 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16109 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
16110 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16111 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16113 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16114 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16115 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16116 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16119 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16120 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16121 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16122 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16123 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16124 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16125 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16126 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16127 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16129 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16131 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16132 &_/some/file_& exists.
16135 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16136 .cindex "load average"
16137 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16138 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16139 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16140 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16141 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16142 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16143 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16146 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16147 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16148 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16149 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16152 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16153 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16154 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16155 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16156 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16157 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16158 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16159 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16160 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16161 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16162 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16163 re-evaluated for each message.
16166 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16167 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16168 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16169 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16170 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16171 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16174 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16175 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16176 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16177 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16178 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16179 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16180 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16181 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16182 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16183 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16184 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16185 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16186 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16190 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16191 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16192 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16193 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16194 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16195 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16196 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16197 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16198 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16200 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16201 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16202 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16203 the daemon's command line.
16205 .cindex queues named
16206 .cindex "named queues"
16207 To set limits for different named queues use
16208 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16210 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16211 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16212 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16213 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16214 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16215 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16216 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16217 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16218 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16219 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16220 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16221 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16222 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16226 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16227 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16228 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16229 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16230 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16231 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16232 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16234 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16235 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16236 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16237 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16238 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16239 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16240 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16241 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16242 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16243 header lines. The default setting is:
16246 received_header_text = Received: \
16247 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16248 {${if def:sender_ident \
16249 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16250 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16251 by $primary_hostname \
16252 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16253 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16254 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16255 ${if def:sender_address \
16256 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16257 id $message_exim_id\
16258 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16261 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16262 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16263 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16264 header lines such as the following:
16266 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16267 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16268 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16269 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16270 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16271 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16272 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16274 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16275 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16276 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16277 message was accepted.
16280 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16281 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16282 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16283 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16284 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16285 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16286 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16287 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16290 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16291 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16292 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16293 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16294 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16295 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16296 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16297 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16298 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16299 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16300 option was not set.
16303 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16304 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16305 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16306 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16307 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16308 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16309 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16310 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16313 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16314 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16315 RCPT commands in a single message.
16318 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16319 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16320 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16321 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16322 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16323 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16324 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16327 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16328 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16329 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16330 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16331 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16332 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16333 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16334 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16335 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16336 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16337 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16338 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16339 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16340 tagged with its process id.
16342 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16343 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16344 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16345 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16348 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16349 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16350 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16351 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16352 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16353 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16354 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16355 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16356 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16357 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16358 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16360 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16361 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16362 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16363 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16366 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16367 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16368 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16369 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16370 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16372 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16374 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16375 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16378 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16379 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16380 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16381 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16382 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16386 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16387 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16388 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16389 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16390 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16391 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16392 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16396 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16397 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16398 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16399 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16400 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16401 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16402 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16403 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16404 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16405 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16408 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16409 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16412 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16414 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16415 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16416 an item in the list.
16417 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16420 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16421 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16422 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16423 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16424 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16427 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16428 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16429 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16430 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16431 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16432 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16433 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16434 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16435 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16436 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16438 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16439 .cindex "environment"
16440 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16441 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16442 default list is empty,
16445 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16446 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16447 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16448 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16449 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16450 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16451 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16455 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16456 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16457 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16458 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16459 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16460 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16461 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16462 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16463 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16464 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16465 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16469 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16470 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16471 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16473 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16474 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16475 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16476 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16477 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16478 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16480 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16481 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16482 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16483 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16486 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16487 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16488 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16489 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16490 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16491 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16492 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16493 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16495 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16496 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16497 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16498 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16499 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16500 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16501 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16502 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16505 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16506 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16507 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16508 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16512 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16513 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16514 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16515 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16516 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16517 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16518 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16519 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16520 . the option name to split.
16522 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16523 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16524 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16525 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16526 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16527 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16528 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16529 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16530 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16534 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16535 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16536 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16537 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16538 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16539 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16540 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16541 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16542 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16543 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16544 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16546 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16547 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16548 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16549 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16550 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16551 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16555 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16556 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16557 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16558 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16559 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16560 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16561 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16562 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16563 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16564 to all messages received in the same connection.
16566 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16567 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16568 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16569 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16572 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16574 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16575 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16576 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16577 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16578 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16579 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16580 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16581 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16582 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16583 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16584 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16585 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16586 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16589 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16590 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16591 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16592 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16593 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16594 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16595 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16596 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16597 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16598 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16599 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16602 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16603 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16604 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16605 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16608 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16609 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16610 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16611 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16612 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16613 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16614 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16615 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16616 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16618 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16619 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16620 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16621 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16623 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16624 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16625 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16626 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16627 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16630 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16631 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16634 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16635 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16636 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16637 &%helo_data%& value.
16639 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16640 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16641 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16642 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16643 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16644 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16645 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16647 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16648 $version_number $tod_full
16650 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16651 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16652 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16653 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16654 multiline response).
16657 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16658 .cindex "checking disk space"
16659 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16660 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16661 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16662 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16663 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16664 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16665 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16668 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16669 .cindex "connection backlog"
16670 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16671 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16672 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16673 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16674 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16675 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16676 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16677 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16678 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16679 attacks by SYN flooding.
16682 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16683 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16684 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16685 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16686 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16687 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16688 fewer, but they still exist.
16690 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16691 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16692 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16693 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16694 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16695 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16696 does detect many instances.
16698 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16699 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16700 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16701 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16705 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16706 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16707 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16708 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16709 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16710 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16711 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16712 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16715 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16716 $sender_host_address
16718 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16719 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16720 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16721 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16722 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16726 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16727 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16728 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16729 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16730 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16733 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16734 .cindex "load average"
16735 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16736 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16737 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16738 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16739 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16740 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16744 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16745 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16746 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16747 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16748 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16750 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16752 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16753 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16754 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16755 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16756 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16758 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16759 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16760 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16761 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16762 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16763 not count towards the limit.
16767 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16768 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16769 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16770 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16771 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16774 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16775 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16779 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16780 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16781 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16782 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16783 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16784 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16787 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16788 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16789 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16790 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16792 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16793 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16794 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16795 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16799 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16801 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16802 fractional parts are allowed here.
16804 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16806 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16807 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16810 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16811 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16813 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16814 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16816 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16817 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16818 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16819 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16822 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16823 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16826 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16827 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16830 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16831 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16832 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16833 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16834 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16835 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16836 the message is abandoned.
16837 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16839 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16840 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16842 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16843 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16845 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16846 expanded before use and may depend on
16847 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16851 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16852 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16853 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16854 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16855 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16858 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16859 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16860 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16863 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16864 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16865 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16866 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16867 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16868 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16869 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16870 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16871 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16872 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16874 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16875 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16879 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16880 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16881 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16882 the availability thereof is advertised in
16883 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16884 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16887 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
16888 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16889 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16890 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16895 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
16896 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
16897 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
16902 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16903 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16904 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16905 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16906 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16907 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16908 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16909 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16910 arrival of the message.
16912 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16913 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16914 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16915 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16916 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16918 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16919 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16920 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16921 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16922 automatically deleted.
16924 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16925 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16926 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16927 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16928 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16929 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16930 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16931 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16932 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16935 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16936 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16937 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16938 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16939 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16940 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16941 &$primary_hostname$&.
16943 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16944 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16945 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16946 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16947 as failures in the configuration file.
16949 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16950 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16952 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
16953 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
16954 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternate format
16955 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
16956 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
16957 Currently it is only done for messages received using the EMSTP CHUNKING
16960 The following variables will not have useful values:
16962 $max_received_linelength
16967 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
16968 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
16969 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
16970 will need to be aware of the potential different format.
16972 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
16973 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
16974 The transmission benefit is maintained.
16976 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16977 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16978 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16979 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16981 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16982 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16983 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16984 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16985 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16986 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16988 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16989 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16990 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16991 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16992 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16993 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16994 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16997 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16998 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16999 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17000 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17001 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17002 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17003 domain causes a syntax error.
17004 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17008 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17009 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17010 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17011 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17012 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17013 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17014 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17015 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17016 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17017 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17018 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17019 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17022 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17023 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17024 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17025 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17026 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17027 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17028 details of Exim's logging.
17031 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17032 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17033 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17034 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17035 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17036 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17037 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17041 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17042 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17043 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17044 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17045 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17049 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17050 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17051 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17052 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17053 details of Exim's logging.
17056 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17057 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17058 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17059 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17060 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17061 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17062 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17063 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17064 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17065 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17066 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17067 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17070 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17071 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17072 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17073 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17074 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17075 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17078 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17079 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17080 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17081 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17082 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17084 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17085 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17086 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17087 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17088 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17090 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17091 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17092 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17093 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17094 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17095 contains the pipe command.
17098 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17099 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17100 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17101 is used in a system filter.
17104 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17105 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17106 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17107 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17108 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17109 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17110 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17111 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17112 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17113 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17115 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17116 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17117 transport option overrides.
17120 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17121 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17122 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17123 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17124 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17125 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17126 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17127 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17128 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17129 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17130 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17131 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17135 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17136 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17137 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17138 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17139 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17140 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17141 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17142 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17143 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17144 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17146 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17147 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17148 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17151 .option timezone main string unset
17152 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17153 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17154 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17155 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17156 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17157 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17161 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17162 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17163 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17164 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17165 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17166 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17169 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17170 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17171 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17172 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17173 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17174 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17175 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17176 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17177 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17178 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17179 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17182 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17183 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17184 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17185 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17186 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17188 The server's private key is also
17189 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17190 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17192 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17193 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17194 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17195 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17197 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17198 separator in the usual way to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17200 &*Note*&: Under current versions of OpenSSL, when a list of more than one
17201 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17203 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17204 when a list of more than one file is used.
17206 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17207 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17208 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17209 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17211 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17212 generated for every connection.
17214 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17215 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17216 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17217 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17218 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17221 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17223 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17224 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17225 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17228 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17231 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17232 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17233 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17234 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17235 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17236 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17238 The value must be at least 1024.
17240 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17241 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17242 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17244 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17247 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17248 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17249 larger prime than requested.
17252 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17253 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17254 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17255 to be used by Exim.
17257 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17258 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17259 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17260 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17262 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17263 then it names a file from which DH
17264 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17265 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17266 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17267 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17268 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17269 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17271 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17274 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17275 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17276 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17277 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17279 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17280 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17282 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17283 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17284 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17286 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17287 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17288 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17289 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17290 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17292 The available standard primes are:
17293 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17294 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17295 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17296 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17298 The available additional primes are:
17299 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17301 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17302 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17303 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17304 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17305 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17307 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17308 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17309 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17311 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17312 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17313 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17314 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17315 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17318 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17319 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17320 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17321 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17322 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17323 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17324 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17327 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17328 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17329 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17330 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17332 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17333 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17334 for valid selections.
17336 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17337 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17338 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17340 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17343 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17344 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17345 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17347 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17348 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17349 Certificate Authority.
17351 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17354 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17355 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17356 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17360 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17363 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17364 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17365 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17366 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17370 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17371 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17372 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17373 files which contains the server's private keys.
17374 If this option is unset, or if
17375 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17376 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17377 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17379 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17382 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17383 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17384 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17385 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17386 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17387 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17391 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17392 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17393 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17394 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17395 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17396 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17397 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17398 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17399 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17400 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17401 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17404 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17405 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17406 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17407 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17410 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17411 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17412 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17413 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17415 or the absolute path to
17416 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17417 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17419 The "system" value for the option will use a
17420 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17421 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17422 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17425 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17426 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17428 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17430 either by file or directory
17431 are added to those given by the system default location.
17433 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17434 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17435 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17436 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17437 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17438 use the explicit directory version.
17440 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17442 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17446 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17447 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17448 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17449 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17450 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17451 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17452 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17453 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17455 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17456 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17457 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17458 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17459 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17460 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17461 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17463 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17464 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17465 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17466 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17467 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17468 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17469 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17472 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17476 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17477 .cindex "trusted groups"
17478 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17479 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17480 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17481 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17482 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17483 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17484 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17487 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17488 .cindex "trusted users"
17489 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17490 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17491 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17492 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17493 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17494 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17495 Exim user are trusted.
17497 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17498 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17499 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17500 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17501 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17502 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17503 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17504 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17505 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17508 .option unknown_username main string unset
17509 See &%unknown_login%&.
17511 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17512 .cindex "trusted users"
17513 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17514 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17515 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17516 .cindex "envelope sender"
17517 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17518 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17519 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17520 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17521 is used) is ignored.
17523 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17524 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17526 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17528 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17529 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17530 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17531 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17532 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17533 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17534 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17535 followed by a hyphen
17536 by a setting like this:
17538 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17540 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17541 restriction, you can use
17543 untrusted_set_sender = *
17545 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17546 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17547 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17548 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17549 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17550 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17551 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17552 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17554 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17555 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17556 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17557 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17561 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17562 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17563 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17564 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17565 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17566 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17567 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17568 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17569 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17570 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17572 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17573 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17575 The pattern can be seen by running
17577 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17579 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17580 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17581 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17582 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17583 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17584 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17587 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17588 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17591 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17592 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17593 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17594 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17595 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17596 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17597 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17598 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17601 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17602 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17603 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17604 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17605 .ecindex IIDconfima
17606 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17611 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17612 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17614 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17615 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17616 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17617 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17618 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
17620 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17621 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17622 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17623 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17624 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17628 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17629 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17630 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17631 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17632 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17633 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17634 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17636 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17637 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17638 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17639 routers, and the eventual transport.
17641 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17642 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17643 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17644 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17645 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17647 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17648 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17649 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17650 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17651 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17653 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17654 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17655 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17657 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17659 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17661 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17663 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17664 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17666 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17667 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17668 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17669 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17670 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17671 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17672 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17676 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17678 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17679 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17680 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17681 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17682 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17687 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17688 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17689 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17690 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17691 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17692 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17693 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17694 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17695 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17696 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17699 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17701 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17704 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17706 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17707 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17708 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17709 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17712 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17713 .cindex "case of local parts"
17714 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17715 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17716 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17717 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17718 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17719 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17720 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17723 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17724 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17725 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17726 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17727 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17728 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17729 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17730 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17731 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17733 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17734 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17735 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17736 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17740 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17741 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17742 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17743 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17745 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17746 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17747 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17748 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17749 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17750 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17751 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17752 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17753 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17754 the router is skipped.
17756 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17757 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17758 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17759 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17760 setting to achieve this. For example:
17762 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17764 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17765 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17766 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17770 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17771 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17772 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17773 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17774 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17775 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17776 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17777 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17779 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17780 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17782 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17783 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17785 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17786 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17787 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17789 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17791 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17793 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17796 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17798 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17799 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17803 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17804 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17805 be specified using &%condition%&.
17807 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17808 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17809 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17810 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17811 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17812 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17813 Router rules processing behavior.
17815 This is best illustrated in an example:
17817 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17818 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17820 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17823 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17826 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17827 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17828 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17829 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17830 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17831 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17832 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17833 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17835 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17836 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17837 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17838 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17841 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17842 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17843 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17844 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17845 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17848 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17849 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17850 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17851 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17852 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17853 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17854 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17855 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17856 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17857 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17858 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17859 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17860 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17861 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17865 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17866 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17867 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17868 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17869 transport option of the same name.
17871 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17872 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17873 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17874 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17875 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17876 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17877 the dnssec request bit set.
17878 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17880 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17881 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17882 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17883 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17884 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17885 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
17886 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17887 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17888 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17891 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17892 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17893 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17894 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17895 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17896 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17897 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17898 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17902 .option driver routers string unset
17903 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17907 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17908 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17909 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17910 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17911 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17912 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17913 Not effective on redirect routers.
17917 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17918 .cindex "envelope sender"
17919 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17920 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17921 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17922 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17923 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17924 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17925 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17927 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17928 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17929 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17932 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17933 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17934 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17935 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17937 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17938 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17939 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17940 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17946 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17947 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17948 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17949 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17950 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17952 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17953 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17954 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17955 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17956 setting &%return_path%&.
17958 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17959 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17960 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17964 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17965 .cindex "address" "testing"
17966 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17967 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17968 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17969 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17970 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17971 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17972 on for the system alias file.
17973 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17976 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17977 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17978 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17982 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17983 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17984 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17985 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17989 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17990 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17991 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17995 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17996 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17997 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18001 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18002 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18003 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18004 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18005 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18006 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
18007 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18008 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18009 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18011 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18012 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18013 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18014 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18015 transport for further details.
18018 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18019 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18020 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18021 .cindex "transport" "local"
18022 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18023 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18024 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18026 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18027 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18028 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18029 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18030 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18034 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18035 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18036 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18037 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18038 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18039 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18040 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18041 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18042 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18043 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18044 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18045 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18046 &"see"& the added header lines.
18048 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18049 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18050 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18051 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18053 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18054 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18056 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18057 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18059 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18060 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18061 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18062 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18063 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18064 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18065 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18066 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18067 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18068 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18072 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18073 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18074 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18075 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18076 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18077 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18078 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18079 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18080 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18081 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18082 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18083 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18084 &"see"& the original header lines.
18086 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18087 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18088 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18091 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18092 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18094 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18095 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18097 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18098 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18099 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18100 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18102 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18103 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18104 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18108 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18109 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18110 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18111 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18112 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18113 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18114 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18117 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18121 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18123 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18124 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18125 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18126 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18127 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18128 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18130 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18131 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18133 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18134 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18136 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18137 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18139 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18140 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18141 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18142 domain that is being routed.
18144 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18145 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18148 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18149 .cindex "additional groups"
18150 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18151 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18152 .cindex "transport" "local"
18153 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18154 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18155 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18156 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18157 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18161 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18162 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18163 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18164 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18165 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18166 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18169 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18170 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18171 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18172 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18173 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18174 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18175 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18176 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18177 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18179 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18180 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18181 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18182 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18183 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18184 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18185 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18186 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18187 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18188 the relevant transport.
18190 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18191 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18192 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18195 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18196 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18197 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18198 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18199 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18203 local_part_prefix = real-
18205 transport = local_delivery
18207 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18208 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18210 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18211 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18214 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18215 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18216 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18217 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18220 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18221 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18225 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18226 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18227 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18228 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18229 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18230 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18231 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18232 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18233 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18237 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18238 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18242 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18243 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18244 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18245 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18246 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18248 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18249 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18252 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18254 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18255 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18256 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18257 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18258 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18259 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18260 each virtual domain:
18264 local_parts = postmaster
18265 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18269 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18270 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18271 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18272 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18273 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18274 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18275 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18276 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18277 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18278 redirect addresses.
18282 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18283 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18284 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18285 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18286 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18287 delivery to be deferred.
18289 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18290 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18292 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18293 means of the setting
18297 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18298 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18299 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18301 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18302 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18303 controls what happens next.
18306 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18307 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18308 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18309 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18310 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18311 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18312 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18313 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18315 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18316 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18317 applies to all of them.
18321 .option pass_router routers string unset
18322 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18323 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18324 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18325 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18326 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18327 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18328 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18329 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18330 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18331 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18335 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18336 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18337 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18338 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18339 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18340 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18342 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18343 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18344 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18345 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18349 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18350 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18351 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18352 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18353 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18354 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18355 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18357 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18358 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18359 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18360 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18362 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18363 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18364 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18365 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18366 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18369 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18370 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18373 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18374 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18375 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18376 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18377 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18378 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18379 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18380 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18382 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18383 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18384 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18385 operates as follows:
18387 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18388 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18389 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18390 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18393 require_files = mail:/some/file
18394 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18396 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18397 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18399 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18400 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18401 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18402 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18404 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18405 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18406 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18407 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18408 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18410 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18411 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18412 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18413 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18414 check again in that process.
18416 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18417 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18418 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18419 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18420 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18421 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18422 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18424 require_files = +/some/file
18426 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18427 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18428 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18432 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18433 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18434 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18435 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18436 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18437 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18438 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18439 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18442 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18443 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18444 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18445 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18446 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18449 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18450 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18451 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18455 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18456 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18457 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18459 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18460 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18461 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18462 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18463 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18464 cause the router to defer.
18466 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18467 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18469 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18471 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18472 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18474 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18475 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18476 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18477 of these values that is set:
18480 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18482 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18484 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18486 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18489 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18490 router, but not for the transport.
18494 .option self routers string freeze
18495 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18496 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18497 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18498 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18499 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18500 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18502 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18503 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18504 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18505 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18506 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18508 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18509 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18510 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18511 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18512 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18517 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18519 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18520 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18521 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18522 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18524 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18525 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18526 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18531 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18532 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18533 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18534 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18535 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18536 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18542 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18543 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18544 be passed to the next router.
18547 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18550 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18551 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18552 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18553 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18554 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18555 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18560 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18561 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18562 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18563 address matches something on the list.
18564 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18567 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18568 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18569 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18570 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18571 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18572 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18573 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18577 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18578 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18579 .cindex "packet radio"
18580 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18581 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18582 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18583 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18584 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18585 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18586 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18587 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18589 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18590 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18591 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18592 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18593 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18594 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18595 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18596 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18597 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18598 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18600 translate_ip_address = \
18601 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18604 The file would contain lines like
18606 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18607 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18609 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18614 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18615 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18616 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18617 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18618 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18619 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18620 delivery is deferred.
18622 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18623 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18624 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18628 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18629 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18630 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18631 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18632 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18633 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18634 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18635 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18636 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18637 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18638 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18644 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18645 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18646 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18647 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18648 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18649 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18650 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18651 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18652 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18653 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18655 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18656 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18657 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18658 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18659 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18661 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18667 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18668 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18669 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18670 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18671 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18672 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18673 delivery to be deferred.
18675 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18676 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18677 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18678 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18679 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18680 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18682 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18683 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18684 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18685 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18686 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18687 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18688 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18689 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18691 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18692 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18693 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18694 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18695 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18696 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18697 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18698 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18699 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18700 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18702 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18703 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18704 subsequent routers.
18707 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18708 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18709 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18710 .cindex "transport" "local"
18711 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18712 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18713 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18714 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18715 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18716 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18717 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18718 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18719 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18720 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18721 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18722 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18726 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18727 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18728 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18731 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18732 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18734 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18735 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18736 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18737 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18738 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18739 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18740 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18742 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18743 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18744 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18748 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18749 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18751 delivering in cutthrough mode
18752 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18753 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18755 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18758 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18759 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18760 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18761 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18763 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18764 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18765 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18772 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18773 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18775 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18776 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18777 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18778 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18779 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18780 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18781 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18782 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18783 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18787 domains = mydomain.example
18789 transport = local_delivery
18791 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18792 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18793 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18794 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18801 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18802 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18804 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18805 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18806 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18807 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18808 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18809 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18811 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18812 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18813 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18814 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18817 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18818 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18819 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18821 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18823 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18824 generic option, the router declines.
18826 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18827 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18828 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18830 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18831 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18832 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18833 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18834 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18835 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18838 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18839 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18840 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18841 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18842 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18843 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18845 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18846 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18847 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18848 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18849 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18850 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18851 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18852 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18853 case routing fails.
18856 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18857 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18858 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18859 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18860 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18862 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18863 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18865 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18867 The domain does not exist in DNS
18869 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18870 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18871 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18873 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18875 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18877 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18878 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18880 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18881 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18883 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18884 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18886 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18887 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18893 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18894 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18895 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18897 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18898 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18899 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18900 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18901 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18902 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18903 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18906 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18907 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18908 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18909 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18910 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18911 required. For example,
18915 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18916 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18917 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18918 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18919 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18922 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18923 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18924 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18925 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18926 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18927 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18929 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18930 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18931 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18932 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18933 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18934 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18935 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18936 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18938 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18939 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18944 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18945 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18946 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18947 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18948 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18949 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18950 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18951 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18956 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
18957 .cindex IPv6 disabling
18958 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
18959 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18960 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18961 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18962 only A records are used.
18964 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
18965 .cindex IPv4 preference
18966 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
18967 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18968 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18969 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18970 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
18973 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18974 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18975 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18976 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18977 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18978 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18979 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18982 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18984 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18985 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18986 the address record.
18989 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18990 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18991 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18992 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18997 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18998 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18999 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19000 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19001 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19002 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19003 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19004 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19005 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19010 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19011 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19012 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19013 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19014 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19015 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19016 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19017 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19018 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19019 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19020 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19022 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19023 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19026 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19027 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19028 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19029 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19030 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19034 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19035 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19036 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19037 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19038 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19039 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19040 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19041 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19043 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19044 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19045 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19046 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19047 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19048 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19049 without processing them independently,
19050 provided the following conditions are met:
19053 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19054 &%headers_remove%&.
19056 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19063 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19064 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19065 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19066 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19067 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19068 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19069 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19070 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19071 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19072 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19074 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19075 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19080 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19081 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19082 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19083 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19088 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19089 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19090 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19091 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19094 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19096 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19097 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19098 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19099 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19100 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19101 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19104 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19105 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19106 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19107 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19108 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19110 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19111 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19112 such as that implied by
19116 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19117 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19118 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19119 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19129 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19130 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19132 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19133 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19134 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19135 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19136 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19137 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19138 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19139 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19140 router handles the address
19144 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19145 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19146 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19148 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19150 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19151 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19153 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19154 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19155 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19156 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19158 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19159 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19160 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19161 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19165 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19168 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19169 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19170 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19171 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19172 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19173 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19176 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19178 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19180 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19181 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19182 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19183 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19184 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19185 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19186 must not be specified for it.
19188 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19189 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19190 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19191 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19192 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19193 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19194 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19197 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19198 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19199 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19200 delivery to the address is deferred.
19203 .option port iplookup integer 0
19204 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19205 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19209 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19210 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19211 protocols is to be used.
19214 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19215 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19218 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19220 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19221 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19224 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19225 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19226 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19227 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19228 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19229 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19230 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19231 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19234 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19235 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19236 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19237 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19238 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19239 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19240 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19241 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19242 following could be used:
19244 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19245 reroute = $local_part@$1
19248 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19249 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19250 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19251 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19256 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19257 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19259 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19260 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19261 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19262 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19263 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19264 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19265 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19266 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19267 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19268 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19270 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19271 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19272 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19273 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19274 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19275 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19276 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19279 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19280 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19281 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19282 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19283 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19284 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19285 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19288 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19289 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19290 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19291 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19292 below, following the list of private options.
19295 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19297 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19298 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19300 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19301 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19303 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19304 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19305 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19306 of the following values:
19315 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19316 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19317 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19320 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19321 router only if &%more%& is true.
19323 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19324 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19325 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19326 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19328 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19329 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19330 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19333 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19334 .cindex "randomized host list"
19335 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19336 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19337 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19338 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19339 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19340 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19341 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19342 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19344 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19345 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19346 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19347 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19349 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19351 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19352 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19353 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19354 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19355 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19358 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19359 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19360 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19363 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19365 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19366 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19370 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19371 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19372 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19373 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19376 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19377 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19378 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19379 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19380 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19381 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19382 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19383 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19385 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19386 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19387 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19388 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19389 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19390 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19391 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19392 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19397 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19398 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19399 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19400 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19401 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19402 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19404 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19406 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19410 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19411 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19413 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19414 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19415 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19416 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19417 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19418 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19419 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19420 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19421 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19422 in a &%route_list%&).
19424 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19425 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19426 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19427 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19431 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19432 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19433 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19434 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19435 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19436 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19437 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19440 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19441 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19443 This data can be accessed by setting
19445 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19447 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19448 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19449 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19450 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19451 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19456 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19457 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19458 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19459 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19460 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19461 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19462 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19464 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19465 variables are set during its expansion:
19468 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19469 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19470 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19472 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19475 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19477 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19480 .vindex "&$value$&"
19481 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19482 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19484 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19488 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19489 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19493 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19494 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19495 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19496 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19497 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19498 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19501 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19502 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19503 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19505 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19506 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19509 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19510 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19511 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19512 number follows. For example:
19514 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19518 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19519 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19520 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19521 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19522 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19525 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19526 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19527 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19528 records in the DNS. For example:
19530 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19532 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19535 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19537 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19538 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19539 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19540 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19541 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19542 happens is controlled by the
19543 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19544 &%self%& option of the router.
19546 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19547 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19548 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19549 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19550 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19551 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19552 defined by MX preferences.
19554 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19555 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19556 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19558 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19559 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19560 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19561 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19563 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19564 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19567 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19568 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19569 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19571 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19572 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19576 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19577 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19578 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19579 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19580 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19581 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19582 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19585 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19586 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19588 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19589 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19591 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19592 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19593 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19595 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19596 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19597 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19600 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19602 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19608 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19609 domain2 host4:host5
19611 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19612 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19613 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19614 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19617 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19618 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19619 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19620 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19623 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19624 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19629 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19630 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19633 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19634 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19638 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19639 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19640 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19643 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19644 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19645 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19646 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19648 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19650 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19651 your first router something like this:
19654 driver = manualroute
19655 domains = !+local_domains
19656 transport = remote_smtp
19657 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19659 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19660 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19661 they are tried in order
19662 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19663 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19666 driver = manualroute
19667 transport = remote_smtp
19668 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19670 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19671 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19672 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19673 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19674 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19675 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19676 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19677 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19680 .cindex "mail hub example"
19681 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19682 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19683 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19684 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19685 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19686 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19687 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19688 lookup is easier to manage.
19690 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19691 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19695 driver = manualroute
19696 transport = remote_smtp
19697 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19699 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19700 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19701 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19702 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19703 domain can be used to find the host:
19706 driver = manualroute
19707 transport = remote_smtp
19708 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19710 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19711 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19712 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19716 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19717 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19718 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19719 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19720 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19721 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19724 driver = manualroute
19725 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19726 route_list = saved.domain.example
19728 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19729 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19730 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19733 driver = manualroute
19735 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19736 *.saved.domain2.example \
19737 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19740 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19742 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19743 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19744 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19745 the address if the lookup fails.
19748 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19749 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19750 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19751 one way it can be done:
19757 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19758 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19759 return_fail_output = true
19764 driver = manualroute
19766 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19768 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19770 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19772 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19773 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19774 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19776 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19777 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19786 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19787 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19789 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19790 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19791 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19792 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19793 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19794 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19795 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19796 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19797 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19798 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19800 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19802 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19803 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19804 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19805 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19806 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19809 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19810 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19811 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19812 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19813 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19814 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19817 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19818 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19819 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19820 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19821 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19822 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19823 not set, a value for the gid also.
19825 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19826 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19827 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19828 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19829 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19830 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19834 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19835 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19836 before running the command.
19839 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19840 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19841 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19845 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19846 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19847 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19848 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19849 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19852 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19855 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19856 &%no_more%& is set.
19858 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19859 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19860 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19861 included in the SMTP response.
19863 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19864 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19865 included in any SMTP response.
19867 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19869 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19870 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19872 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19873 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19874 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19877 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19878 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19881 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19882 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19884 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19885 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19886 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19887 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19889 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19890 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19891 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19892 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19893 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19895 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19896 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19897 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19898 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19899 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19901 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19902 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19903 variable. For example, this return line
19905 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19907 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19908 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19909 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19910 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19915 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19916 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19918 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19919 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19920 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19921 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19922 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19923 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19924 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19925 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19926 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19927 redirected in several different ways:
19930 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19933 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19935 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19937 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19939 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19941 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19943 It can be discarded.
19946 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19947 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19948 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19949 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19951 If success DSNs have been requested
19952 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19953 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19954 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19958 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19959 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19960 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19961 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19962 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19963 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19967 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19969 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19970 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19971 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19972 cause delivery to be deferred.
19974 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19975 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19980 file = $home/.forward
19983 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19984 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19985 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19986 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19991 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19992 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19993 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19994 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19997 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19998 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19999 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20000 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20002 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20003 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20004 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20005 saves some resources.
20013 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20014 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20015 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20016 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20017 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20020 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20021 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20022 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20023 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20024 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20025 document is intended for use by end users.
20027 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20028 described in the next section.
20031 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
20032 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20033 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20034 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20035 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20039 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20040 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20041 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20042 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20043 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20044 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20045 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20046 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20047 commas or newlines.
20048 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20051 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20052 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20053 next newline character is ignored.
20055 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20056 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20057 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20058 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20061 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20062 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20063 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20064 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20065 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20066 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20069 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20073 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20074 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20075 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20076 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20077 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20078 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20079 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20080 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20081 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20082 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20083 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20085 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20086 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20087 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20088 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20089 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20091 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20093 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20094 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20095 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20096 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20097 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20100 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20101 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20102 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20103 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20104 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20106 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20107 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20112 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20113 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20116 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20118 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20119 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20120 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20121 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20122 should really contain
20124 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20126 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20127 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20128 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20132 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20133 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20134 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20137 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20138 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20139 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20140 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20141 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20142 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20143 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20145 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20146 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20147 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20148 in double quotes, for example:
20150 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20152 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20153 quote just the command. An item such as
20155 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20157 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20159 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20160 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20161 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20162 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20163 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20164 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20165 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20166 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20167 an &%accept%& router.
20170 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20171 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20172 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20173 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20175 /home/world/minbari
20177 is treated as a file name, but
20179 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20181 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
20182 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20183 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20184 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20186 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20187 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20189 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20190 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20191 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20192 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20195 .cindex "included address list"
20196 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20197 If an item is of the form
20199 :include:<path name>
20201 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20202 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20203 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20204 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20205 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20206 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20208 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20210 It must be given as
20212 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20215 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20216 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20217 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20218 .cindex "black hole"
20219 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20220 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20221 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20222 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20226 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20227 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20228 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20230 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20231 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20232 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20233 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20237 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20238 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20239 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20240 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20241 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20242 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20243 redirection items of the form
20248 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20249 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20250 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20251 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20253 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20255 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20257 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20258 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20260 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20261 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20262 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20264 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20265 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20266 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20267 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20268 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20269 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20270 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20271 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20272 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20275 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20276 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20277 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20278 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20280 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20281 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20282 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20283 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20284 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20286 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20287 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20288 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20289 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20290 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20294 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20295 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20296 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20297 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20298 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20299 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20300 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20304 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20305 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20306 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20307 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20308 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20309 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20310 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20311 aliasing scheme of the type
20313 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20317 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20318 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20319 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20322 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20323 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20325 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20326 the pipes are distinct.
20330 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20331 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20332 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20333 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20334 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20335 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20336 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20337 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20338 can be used to avoid this.
20341 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20342 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20343 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20344 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20345 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20346 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20347 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20351 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20353 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20354 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20357 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20358 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20359 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20362 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20363 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20364 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20365 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20368 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20369 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20370 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20371 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20372 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20373 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20374 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20376 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20377 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20380 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20381 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20382 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20383 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20384 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20388 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20389 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20390 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20391 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20392 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20393 let ordinary users do.
20397 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20398 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20399 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20400 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20401 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20402 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20404 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20405 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20406 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20407 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20408 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20409 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20411 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20413 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20414 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20415 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20416 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20417 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20418 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20419 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20420 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20423 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20424 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20425 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20426 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20427 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20428 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20429 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20430 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20434 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20435 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20436 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20437 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20438 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20439 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20442 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20443 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20444 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20445 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20446 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20447 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20449 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20450 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20451 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20453 data = #Exim filter\n\
20454 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20456 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20457 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20458 choice into a newline.
20461 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20462 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20463 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20464 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20465 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20468 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20469 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20470 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20471 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20472 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20473 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20474 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20475 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20477 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20478 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20479 runs a check on the containing directory,
20480 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20481 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20482 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20483 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20484 not, the router declines.
20487 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20488 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20489 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20490 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20491 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20492 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20493 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20496 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20497 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20498 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20499 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20500 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20503 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20504 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20505 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20506 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20510 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20511 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20512 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20513 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20514 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20519 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20520 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20521 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20522 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20523 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20524 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20525 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20526 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20527 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20528 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20529 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20532 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20533 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20534 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20535 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20536 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20539 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20540 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20541 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20542 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20543 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20544 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20546 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20547 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20548 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20549 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20550 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20551 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20552 &_.forward_& files).
20555 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20556 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20557 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20558 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20559 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20562 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20563 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20564 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20565 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20566 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20567 of the embedded Perl support.
20570 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20571 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20572 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20573 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20574 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20577 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20578 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20579 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20580 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20581 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20584 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20585 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20586 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20587 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20588 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20589 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20590 &%one_time%& is set.
20593 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20594 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20595 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20596 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20597 to make use of &%run%& items.
20600 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20601 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20602 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20603 If this option is true, items of the form
20605 :include:<path name>
20607 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20610 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20611 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20612 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20613 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20614 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20615 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20616 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20619 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20620 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20621 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20622 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20623 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20626 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20627 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20628 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20629 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20630 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20635 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20636 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20637 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20638 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20639 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20640 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20641 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20644 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20646 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20647 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20648 file did not exist.
20651 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20653 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20654 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20655 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20657 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20658 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20659 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20660 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20661 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20662 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20663 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20664 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20668 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20669 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20670 redirection list must start with this directory.
20673 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20674 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20675 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20678 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20679 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20680 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20681 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20682 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20683 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20684 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20685 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20686 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20687 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20688 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20689 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20690 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20691 before they subscribed.
20693 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20694 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20695 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20696 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20699 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20700 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20701 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20702 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20704 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20705 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20706 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20708 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20711 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20712 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20713 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20714 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20715 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20719 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20720 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20721 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20722 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20723 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20724 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20725 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20726 See &%check_owner%& above.
20729 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20730 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20731 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20732 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20735 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20736 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20737 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20738 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20739 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20740 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20741 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20744 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20745 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20746 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20747 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20748 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20749 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20750 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20751 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20753 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20754 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20755 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20758 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20759 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20760 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20761 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20762 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20763 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20764 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20765 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20766 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20767 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20770 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20771 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20772 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20773 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20774 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20775 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20778 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20779 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20780 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20781 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20782 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20783 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20786 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20787 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20788 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20789 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20790 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20793 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20794 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20795 :subaddress part of an address.
20797 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20798 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20799 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20800 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20803 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20804 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20805 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20806 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20807 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20808 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20809 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20813 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20814 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20815 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20816 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20817 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20818 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20819 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20820 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20821 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20822 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20823 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20824 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20825 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20826 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20827 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20828 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20830 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20831 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20832 the following routers.
20834 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20835 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20836 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20837 so it is passed to the following routers.
20839 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20840 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20841 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20842 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20844 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20845 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20846 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20847 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20853 file = $home/.forward
20854 file_transport = address_file
20855 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20856 reply_transport = address_reply
20859 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20860 syntax_errors_text = \
20861 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20862 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20863 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20864 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20865 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20866 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20867 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20868 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20869 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20870 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20872 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20873 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20874 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20879 local_part_prefix = real-
20880 transport = local_delivery
20882 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20883 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20885 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20886 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20890 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20891 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20894 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20895 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20896 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20897 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20904 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20905 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20907 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20908 "Environment for local transports"
20909 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20910 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
20911 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20912 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20913 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20914 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20915 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20917 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20918 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20919 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20920 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20922 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20923 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20924 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20925 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20926 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20930 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20931 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20932 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20933 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20934 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20935 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20936 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20939 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20940 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20944 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20946 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20947 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20948 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20949 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20954 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20955 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20956 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20957 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20958 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20959 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20960 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20961 group (set by the transport). For example:
20964 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20968 transport = group_delivery
20971 # This transport overrides the group
20973 driver = appendfile
20974 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20977 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20978 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20979 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20982 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20983 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20984 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20985 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20986 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20987 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20989 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20990 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20991 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20992 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20993 original gid is also used.
20995 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20996 following that is set is used:
20999 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21001 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21003 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21004 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21006 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21008 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21009 the uid is the creator's uid;
21011 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21014 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21015 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21016 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21017 The first of the following that is set is used:
21020 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21022 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21024 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21026 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21031 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21032 &%never_users%& list.
21038 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21039 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21040 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21041 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21042 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21043 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21044 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21045 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21046 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21047 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21050 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21052 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21054 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21056 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21059 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21062 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21064 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21068 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21069 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21070 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21074 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21075 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21076 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21077 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21078 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21079 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21080 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21081 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21082 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21083 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21084 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21085 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21086 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21087 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21095 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21096 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21098 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21099 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21100 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21101 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21102 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21105 .option body_only transports boolean false
21106 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21107 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21108 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21109 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21110 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21111 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21112 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21113 automatically suppress them.
21116 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21117 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21118 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21119 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21120 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21121 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21124 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21125 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21126 deliveries by the transport or for any
21127 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21128 what you are doing.
21131 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21132 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21133 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21134 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21136 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21137 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21138 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21139 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21140 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21141 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21143 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21144 transport and the router that called it.
21146 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21147 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21148 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21149 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21150 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21151 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21152 safely be resent to other recipients.
21155 .option driver transports string unset
21156 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21157 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21160 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21161 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21162 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21163 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21164 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21165 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21166 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21167 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21168 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21169 resent to other recipients.
21172 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21174 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21175 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21178 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21179 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21180 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21181 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21182 &%user%& (see below).
21185 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21186 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21187 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21188 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21189 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
21190 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21191 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21192 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21193 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21194 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21195 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21197 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21198 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21201 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21202 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21203 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21204 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21205 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21206 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21207 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21208 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21211 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21212 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21213 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21214 This option specifies a list of header names,
21215 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
21216 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21217 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21219 Each list item is separately expanded.
21220 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21221 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21222 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21224 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21225 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21227 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21228 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21229 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21233 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21234 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21235 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21236 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21237 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21238 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21239 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21240 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21243 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21246 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21247 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21248 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21249 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21250 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21251 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21252 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21253 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21254 change envelope recipients at this time.
21257 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21258 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21260 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21261 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21262 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21263 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21264 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21265 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21266 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21270 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21271 .cindex "additional groups"
21272 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21273 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21274 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21275 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21276 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21279 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21280 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21281 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21282 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21283 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21284 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21285 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21286 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21288 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21289 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21290 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21291 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21292 Obviously there is scope for
21293 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21294 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21296 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21297 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21298 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21299 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21300 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21303 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21304 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21305 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21306 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21307 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21308 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21309 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21310 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21311 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21312 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21313 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21314 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21315 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21320 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21321 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21322 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21323 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21324 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21325 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21326 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21327 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21330 local_part_prefix = *-
21332 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21335 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21337 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21338 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21339 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21340 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21341 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21344 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21345 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21346 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21347 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21348 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21349 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21350 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21351 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21352 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21354 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21355 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21356 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21357 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21359 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21360 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21361 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21364 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21365 .cindex "envelope sender"
21366 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21367 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21368 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21369 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21370 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21371 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21372 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21373 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21374 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21376 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21377 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21379 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21380 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21381 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21382 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21383 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21384 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21385 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21387 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21388 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21389 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21390 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21391 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21395 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21396 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21397 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21398 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21399 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21400 have easy access to it.
21402 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21403 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21404 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21405 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21406 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21410 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21411 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21414 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21415 .cindex "shadow transport"
21416 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21417 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21418 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21420 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21421 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21422 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21423 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21424 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21425 cause a log line to be written.
21427 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21428 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21429 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21430 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21431 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21434 ST=<shadow transport name>
21436 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21437 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21438 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21439 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21440 headers that some sites insist on.
21443 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21444 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21445 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21446 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21447 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21448 individual users or via a system filter.
21449 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21451 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21452 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21453 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21454 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21455 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21457 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21458 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21459 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21460 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21461 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21462 &(pipe)& transports.
21464 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21465 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21466 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21467 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21468 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21470 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21471 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21472 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21473 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21475 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21476 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21477 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21478 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21479 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21480 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21482 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21483 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21484 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21485 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21486 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21487 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21488 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21489 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21491 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21492 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21493 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21494 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21495 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21496 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21497 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21498 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21499 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21500 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21503 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21504 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21505 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21506 which the message is being sent. For example:
21508 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21509 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21512 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21513 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21514 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21516 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21517 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21518 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21521 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21523 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21524 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21525 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21526 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21527 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21528 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21530 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21531 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21532 arguments. Consider this example:
21534 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21535 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21537 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21538 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21540 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21541 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21545 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21546 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21547 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21548 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21549 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21550 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21551 bounced from a transport filter.
21553 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21554 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21555 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21558 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21559 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21560 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21561 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21562 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21563 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21564 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21565 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21566 becomes a temporary error.
21569 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21570 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21571 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21572 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21573 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21574 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21575 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21578 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21579 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21580 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21582 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21583 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21584 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21585 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21587 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21588 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21589 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21596 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21599 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21601 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21602 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21603 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21604 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21605 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21606 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21607 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21609 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21610 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21611 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21612 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21613 local transport, for example:
21616 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21617 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21618 recipients saves space.
21620 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21621 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21623 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21624 to a scanner program or
21625 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21629 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21630 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21631 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21633 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21634 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21635 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21636 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21637 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21638 to certain conditions:
21641 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21642 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21643 batching is possible.
21645 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21646 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21647 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21649 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21650 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21651 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21652 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21653 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21656 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21657 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21658 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21662 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21663 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21664 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21665 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21666 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21667 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21668 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21671 escape_string = ".."
21673 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21674 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21675 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21677 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21678 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21679 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21680 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21681 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21682 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21684 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21685 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21686 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21687 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21688 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21689 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21690 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21691 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21692 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21697 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21698 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21700 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21701 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21702 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21703 .cindex "directory creation"
21704 .cindex "creating directories"
21705 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21706 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21707 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21708 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21709 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21710 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21711 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21712 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21713 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21714 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21716 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21717 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21718 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21721 .cindex "quota" "system"
21722 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21723 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21724 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21726 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21727 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21728 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21729 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21731 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21732 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21735 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21736 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21737 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21738 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21743 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21744 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21745 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21746 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21747 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21749 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21750 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21751 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21752 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21753 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21754 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21755 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21756 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21757 operation. There are two cases:
21760 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21761 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21762 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21763 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21764 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21765 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21766 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21768 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21769 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21770 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21774 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21775 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21776 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21777 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21782 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21784 require "fileinto";
21785 fileinto "folder23";
21787 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21788 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21789 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21790 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21791 way of handling this requirement:
21793 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21794 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21795 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21797 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21801 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21802 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21803 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21805 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21806 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21807 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21808 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21809 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21810 path to the transport.
21812 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21813 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21818 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21819 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21823 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21824 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21825 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21826 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21827 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21828 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21829 delivery is deferred.
21832 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21833 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21834 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21835 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21836 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21837 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21838 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21839 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21842 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21843 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21844 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21845 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21849 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21850 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21853 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21854 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21855 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21856 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21857 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21860 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21861 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21862 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21863 process is running.
21866 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21867 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21868 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21869 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21870 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21871 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21872 contains is significant.
21874 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21875 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21876 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21877 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21878 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21880 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21881 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21882 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21883 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21884 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21885 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21887 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21888 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21889 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21890 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21892 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21893 .cindex "directory creation"
21894 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21895 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21896 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21898 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21899 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21900 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21901 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21902 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21906 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21907 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21908 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21909 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21910 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21913 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21914 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21915 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21916 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21917 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21918 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21919 &%file_must_exist%&.
21922 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21923 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21924 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21925 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21927 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21928 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21929 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21930 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21931 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21934 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21936 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21937 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21938 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21939 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21941 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21943 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21944 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21948 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21949 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21950 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21953 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21954 See &%check_string%& above.
21957 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21958 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21959 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21960 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21961 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21962 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21965 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21966 .cindex "locking files"
21967 .cindex "lock files"
21968 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21969 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21971 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21972 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21975 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21976 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21979 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21980 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21981 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21982 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21983 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21984 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21988 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21989 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21990 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21991 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21992 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21993 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21994 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21995 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21996 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21999 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22000 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22002 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22003 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22004 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22005 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22006 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22007 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22008 delivery is deferred.
22011 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22012 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22013 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22014 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22017 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22018 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22019 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22020 .cindex "locking files"
22021 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22022 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22023 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22024 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22025 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22026 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22027 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22028 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22030 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22031 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22032 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22033 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22035 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22036 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22039 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22041 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22042 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22043 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22045 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22046 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22048 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22051 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22052 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22053 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22054 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22057 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22058 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22059 for details of locking.
22062 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22063 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22064 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22067 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22068 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22069 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22072 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22073 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22074 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22075 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22076 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22079 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22080 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22081 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22082 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22083 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22084 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22085 external source that maintains the data.
22088 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22089 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22090 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22091 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22092 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22093 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22094 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22095 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22099 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22100 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22101 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22102 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22103 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22104 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22105 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22106 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22107 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22108 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22111 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22112 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22113 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22114 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22115 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22116 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22117 calculation. The default value is:
22119 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22121 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22122 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22124 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22126 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22128 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22129 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22130 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22131 directly into that directory.
22134 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22135 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22136 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22139 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22140 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22141 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22144 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22145 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22146 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22147 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22148 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22149 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22150 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22151 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22153 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22154 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22155 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22156 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22157 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22158 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22159 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22160 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22161 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22162 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22165 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22166 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22167 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22168 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22169 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22170 below for further details.
22173 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22174 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22175 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22178 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22179 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22180 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22183 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22184 .cindex "locking files"
22185 .cindex "file" "locking"
22186 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22187 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22188 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22189 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22190 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22191 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22192 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22194 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22195 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22196 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22203 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22204 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22205 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22206 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22207 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22208 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22209 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22210 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22212 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22213 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22214 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22215 append messages to it.
22218 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22219 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22220 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22221 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22222 in which case it is:
22224 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22225 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22227 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22228 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22230 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22231 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22232 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22233 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22238 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22239 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22241 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22242 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22243 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22244 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22245 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22246 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22247 value, and this option is ignored.
22250 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22251 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22252 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22253 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22254 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22257 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22258 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22259 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22260 on users about incoming mail.
22263 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22264 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22265 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22266 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22267 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22268 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22269 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22270 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22271 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22273 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22274 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22275 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22277 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22278 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22279 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22280 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22281 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22282 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22284 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22285 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22286 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22287 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22288 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22291 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22292 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22294 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22296 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22297 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22298 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22299 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22300 system quota failures.
22302 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22303 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22304 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22305 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22306 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22307 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22308 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22309 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22310 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22311 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22314 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22315 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22316 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22317 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22318 delivery directory.
22321 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22322 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22323 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22324 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22325 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22328 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22329 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22331 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22332 See &%quota%& above.
22335 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22336 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22337 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22338 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22339 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22340 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22341 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22343 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22344 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22345 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22346 the file length to the file name. For example:
22348 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22349 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22351 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22352 number of lines in the message.
22354 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22355 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22356 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22358 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22361 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22362 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22363 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22365 quota_warn_message = "\
22366 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22367 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22368 This message is automatically created \
22369 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22370 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22371 a warning threshold that is\n\
22372 set by the system administrator.\n"
22376 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22377 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22378 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22379 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22380 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22381 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22382 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22383 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22384 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22388 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22390 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22391 percent sign is ignored.
22393 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22394 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22395 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22396 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22397 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22398 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22400 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22402 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22403 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22406 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22407 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22411 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22412 .cindex "envelope sender"
22413 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22414 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22415 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22416 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22417 for details of batch SMTP.
22420 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22421 .cindex "carriage return"
22423 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22424 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22425 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22426 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22428 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22429 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22430 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22431 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22432 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22433 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22436 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22437 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22438 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22439 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22440 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22441 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22444 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22445 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22446 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22447 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22448 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22450 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22451 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22452 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22453 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22455 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22456 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22457 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22458 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22459 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22462 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22463 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22466 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22467 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22468 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22469 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22470 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22471 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22472 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22474 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22475 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22476 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22477 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22480 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22481 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22482 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22485 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22486 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22487 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22488 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22489 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22490 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22491 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22492 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22493 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22495 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22496 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22497 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22498 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22503 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22504 .cindex "appending to a file"
22505 .cindex "file" "appending"
22506 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22509 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22513 .cindex "directory creation"
22514 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22515 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22516 &%directory_mode%& option.
22519 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22520 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22524 .cindex "file" "locking"
22525 .cindex "locking files"
22526 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22527 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22528 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22531 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22532 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22533 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22535 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22537 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22538 Unlink the hitching post name.
22540 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22541 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22542 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22543 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22545 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22546 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22547 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22548 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22549 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22550 it before trying again.
22554 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22555 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22556 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22559 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22560 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22561 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22562 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22563 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22564 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22565 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22566 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22567 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22571 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22572 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22573 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22574 delivery is deferred.
22577 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22578 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22579 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22583 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22584 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22585 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22588 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22589 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22590 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22593 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22594 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22595 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22596 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22597 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22598 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22599 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22600 that prevents link following.
22603 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22604 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22605 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22606 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22607 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22610 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22613 .cindex "file" "locking"
22614 .cindex "locking files"
22615 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22616 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22617 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22618 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22619 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22621 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22623 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22624 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22625 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22627 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22628 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22629 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22631 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22632 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22633 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22634 delivery is deferred.
22636 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22637 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22638 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22639 immediately. It retries up to
22641 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22643 times (rounded up).
22646 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22647 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22650 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22651 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22652 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22653 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22654 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22655 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22656 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22657 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22658 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22659 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22661 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22662 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22663 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22664 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22665 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22666 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22667 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22669 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22670 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22671 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22672 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22675 .cindex "maildir format"
22676 .cindex "mailstore format"
22677 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22678 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22679 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22680 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22681 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22683 .cindex "directory creation"
22684 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22685 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22686 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22687 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22688 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22689 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22694 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22695 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22696 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22697 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22698 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22699 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22700 &_new_& subdirectory.
22702 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22703 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22704 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22705 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22706 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22707 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22708 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22710 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22711 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22712 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22713 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22714 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22715 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22716 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22717 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22719 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22720 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22721 folders. Consider this example:
22723 maildir_format = true
22724 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22725 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22726 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22727 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22729 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22730 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22731 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22732 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22733 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22734 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22736 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22737 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22738 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22739 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22740 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22742 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22743 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22744 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22746 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22747 .cindex "maildir++"
22748 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22749 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22750 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22751 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22752 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22753 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22754 amount of space used.
22756 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22757 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22758 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22759 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22760 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22761 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22766 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22767 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22768 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22769 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22770 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22771 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22774 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22775 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22776 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22777 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22778 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22779 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22780 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22781 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22782 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22783 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22784 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22785 backwards compatibility).
22787 For one common implementation, you might set:
22789 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22791 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22793 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22794 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22795 &[stat()]& each message file.
22798 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22799 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22800 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22801 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22802 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22803 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22804 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22805 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22806 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22808 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22809 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22810 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22811 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22812 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22813 need to know the quota.
22815 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22816 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22818 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22819 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22820 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22824 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22825 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22826 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22827 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22828 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22829 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22830 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22831 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22833 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22834 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22835 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22836 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22837 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22838 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22840 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22841 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22842 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22843 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22844 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22845 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22847 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22848 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22849 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22850 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22853 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22854 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22855 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22856 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22857 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22859 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22861 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22862 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22863 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22864 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22865 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22872 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22873 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22875 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22876 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22877 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22878 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22879 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22880 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22881 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22882 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22884 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22885 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22886 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22887 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22888 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22891 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22892 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22893 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22894 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22895 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22897 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22898 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22899 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22900 transport is run as a consequence of a
22902 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22903 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22904 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22905 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22906 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22907 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22909 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22910 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22911 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22912 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22914 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22915 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22916 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22917 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22918 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22919 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22920 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22922 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22923 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22924 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22925 the transport defers.
22926 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22927 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22929 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22930 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22931 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22932 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22934 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22935 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22936 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22937 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22938 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22939 problems. They are just discarded.
22943 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22944 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22946 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22947 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22948 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22951 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22952 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22953 when the message is specified by the transport.
22956 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22957 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22958 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22959 string comes first.
22962 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22963 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22964 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22967 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22968 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22969 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22972 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22973 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22974 specified by the transport.
22977 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22978 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22979 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22980 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22983 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22984 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22985 the message is specified by the transport.
22988 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22989 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22993 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22994 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22995 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22996 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22997 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23001 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23002 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23003 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23004 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23006 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23007 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
23008 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23009 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23010 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23011 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23012 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23015 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23016 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23017 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23018 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23019 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23021 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23022 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23023 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23024 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23025 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23026 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23029 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23030 See &%once%& above.
23033 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23034 See &%once%& above.
23035 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23038 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23039 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23040 specified by the transport.
23043 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23044 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23045 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23046 configuration option.
23049 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23050 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23051 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23052 automatic responses. For example:
23054 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23056 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23057 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23058 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23059 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23064 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23065 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23066 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23067 the text comes first.
23070 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23071 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23072 when the message is specified by the transport.
23073 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23074 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23079 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23080 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23082 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23083 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23084 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23085 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23086 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23087 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23089 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23090 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23091 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23092 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23093 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23094 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23098 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23099 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23100 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23103 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23104 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23107 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23108 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23109 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23110 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23111 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23114 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23115 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23116 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23117 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23118 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23119 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23122 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23123 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23124 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23125 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23126 in its response to the LHLO command.
23128 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23129 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23130 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23131 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23134 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23135 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23136 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23137 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23142 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23146 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23147 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23151 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23152 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23154 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23155 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23156 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23157 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23158 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23159 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23160 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23161 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23165 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23166 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23167 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23168 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23169 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23171 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23172 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23173 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23174 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23175 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23176 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23177 that are routed to the transport.
23179 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23180 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23181 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23182 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23183 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23184 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23185 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23189 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23190 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23191 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23193 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23194 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23195 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23196 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23197 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23198 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23199 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23202 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23203 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23204 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23205 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23206 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23207 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23208 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23213 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23214 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23215 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23216 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23217 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23218 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23219 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23220 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23221 &"local delivery failed"&.
23223 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23224 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23225 will be sent as normal.
23227 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23228 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23229 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23230 apply in this case.
23232 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23233 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23234 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23235 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23237 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23238 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23239 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23240 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23241 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23242 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23243 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23248 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23249 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23250 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23251 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23252 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23255 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23256 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23257 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23258 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23260 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23261 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23262 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23263 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23264 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23266 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23268 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23269 arguments. You have to write
23271 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23273 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23274 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23275 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23276 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23277 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23278 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23281 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23284 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23285 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23286 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23287 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23288 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23289 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23290 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23291 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23292 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23293 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23295 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23296 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23297 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23298 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23299 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23300 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23301 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23302 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23304 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23305 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23306 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23307 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23308 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23309 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23310 control what is done with it.
23312 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23313 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23314 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23315 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23316 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23317 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23318 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23319 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23320 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23321 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23322 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23326 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23327 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23328 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23329 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23330 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23331 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23332 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23333 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23335 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23336 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23337 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23338 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23339 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23340 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23341 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23342 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23343 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23344 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23345 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23346 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23347 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23348 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23349 &`USER `& see below
23351 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23352 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23353 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23354 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23355 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23356 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23357 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23360 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23361 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23362 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23366 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23367 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23368 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23369 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23372 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23373 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23377 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23378 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23379 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23380 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23381 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23382 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23383 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23384 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23385 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23386 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23387 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23390 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23392 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23393 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23394 &%use_shell%& is set.
23397 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23398 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23401 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23402 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23403 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23406 .option check_string pipe string unset
23407 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23408 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23409 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23410 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23411 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23412 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23413 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23417 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23418 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23419 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23420 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23421 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23422 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23423 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23426 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23427 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23428 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23429 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23430 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23431 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23432 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23435 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23436 See &%check_string%& above.
23439 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23440 .cindex "exec failure"
23441 .cindex "failure of exec"
23442 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23443 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23444 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23445 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23446 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23449 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23450 .cindex "signal exit"
23451 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23452 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23453 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23454 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23457 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23458 .cindex "force command"
23459 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23460 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23461 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23462 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23463 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23464 command. For example:
23466 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23470 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23471 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23472 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23475 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23476 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23477 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23478 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23479 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23480 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23482 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23483 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23486 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23487 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23488 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23489 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23490 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23491 written to the main log.
23494 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23495 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23496 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23497 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23498 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23499 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23503 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23504 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23505 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23506 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23507 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23510 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23511 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23512 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23513 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23514 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23515 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23516 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23517 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23520 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23521 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23522 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23525 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23529 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23530 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23531 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23532 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23533 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23538 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23539 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23542 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23543 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23544 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23545 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23549 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23550 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23553 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23554 This option is expanded and
23555 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23556 variable of the subprocess.
23557 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23558 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23559 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23562 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23563 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23564 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23565 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23566 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23567 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23568 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23569 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23570 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23573 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23574 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23575 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23576 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23577 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23578 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23579 accept the message is used.
23582 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23583 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23584 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23585 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23586 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23587 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23590 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23591 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23592 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23593 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23594 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23595 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23596 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23600 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23601 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23602 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23603 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23604 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23605 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23606 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23607 of them may be set.
23611 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23612 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23613 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23614 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23615 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23616 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23617 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23618 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23619 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23620 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23621 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23622 and 73, respectively.
23625 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23626 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23627 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23628 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23629 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23630 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23631 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23633 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23634 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23635 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23636 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23637 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23638 delivery to be deferred.
23640 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23641 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23644 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23645 .cindex "envelope sender"
23646 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23647 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23648 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23649 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23650 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23652 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23653 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23654 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23655 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23656 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23657 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23661 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23662 .cindex "carriage return"
23664 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23665 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23666 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23667 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23669 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23670 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23671 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23672 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23673 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23676 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23677 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23678 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23679 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23680 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23681 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23682 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23683 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23684 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23689 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23690 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23691 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23692 .cindex "external local delivery"
23693 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23694 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23695 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23696 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23697 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23698 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23699 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23700 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23701 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23702 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23707 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23711 check_string = "From "
23712 escape_string = ">From "
23721 transport = procmail_pipe
23723 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23724 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23725 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23726 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23727 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23728 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23730 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23734 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23735 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23738 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23739 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23742 local_delivery_cyrus:
23744 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23745 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23757 local_part_suffix = .*
23758 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23760 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23761 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23763 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23764 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23767 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23768 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23770 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23771 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23772 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23773 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23774 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23775 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23776 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23777 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23780 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23781 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23785 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23786 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23787 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23788 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23789 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23790 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23791 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23793 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23794 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23795 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23796 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23797 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23798 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23803 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23804 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23805 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23809 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23811 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23812 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23813 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23814 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23815 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23816 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23817 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23818 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23821 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23822 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23823 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23824 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23825 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23826 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23827 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23828 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23829 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23830 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23831 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23832 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23833 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23834 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23836 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23837 and will be removed in a future release.
23840 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23841 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23842 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23845 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23846 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23847 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23848 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23849 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23850 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23851 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23852 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23854 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23855 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23856 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23857 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23858 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23859 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23860 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23861 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23862 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23865 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23867 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23868 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23869 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23870 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23871 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23874 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23875 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23876 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23877 particular connection.
23879 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23880 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23881 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23882 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23884 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23885 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23886 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23888 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23890 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23891 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23893 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23894 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23898 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23899 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23900 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23901 authenticated as a client.
23904 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23905 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23906 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23907 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23910 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23911 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23912 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23913 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23914 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23915 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23916 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23919 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23920 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23921 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23922 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23923 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23924 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23925 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23929 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23930 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23931 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23932 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23935 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
23936 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23937 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23938 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23939 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23940 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
23941 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
23942 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
23943 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23946 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23947 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23948 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23951 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23952 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23953 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23954 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23955 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23956 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23958 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23959 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23960 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23961 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23962 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23963 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23964 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23965 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23969 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23970 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23971 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23972 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23973 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23976 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23977 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23978 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23979 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23983 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23984 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23985 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23986 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23987 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23988 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23989 the dnssec request bit set.
23990 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23994 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23995 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23996 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23997 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23998 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23999 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24000 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24001 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24002 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24006 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24007 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24008 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24009 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24010 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24011 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24012 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24014 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24015 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24016 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24017 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24018 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24021 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24022 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24023 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24024 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24025 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24026 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24027 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24028 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24030 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24031 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24032 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24033 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24034 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24035 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24037 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24038 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24039 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24040 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24041 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24043 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24044 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24045 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24046 copy of the message is sent.
24048 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24049 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24050 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24051 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24055 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24056 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24057 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24060 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24061 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24062 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24063 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24064 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24065 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24067 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24068 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24069 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24070 implementations of TLS.
24072 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24073 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24074 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24075 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24076 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24077 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24078 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24083 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24084 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24085 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24086 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24087 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24088 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24089 interface address, you could use this:
24091 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24092 {$primary_hostname}}
24094 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24097 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24098 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24099 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24100 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24101 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24102 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24104 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24105 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24106 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24107 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24109 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24110 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24111 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24112 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24113 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24114 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24115 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24117 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24118 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24119 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24120 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24121 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24122 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24123 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24126 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24127 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24130 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24131 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24132 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24133 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24134 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24135 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24136 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24137 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24138 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24139 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24142 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24143 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24144 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24145 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24148 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24149 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24150 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24151 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24153 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24154 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24155 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24156 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24157 to any host that matches this list.
24160 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24161 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24162 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24163 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24164 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24165 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24166 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24167 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24170 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24171 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24172 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24177 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24178 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24179 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24180 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24181 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24182 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24183 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24184 explanation of when this might be needed.
24186 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24187 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24188 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24189 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24190 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24191 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24192 message on the same session.
24194 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24195 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24196 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24197 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24198 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24199 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24204 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24205 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24206 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24207 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24208 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24211 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24212 .cindex "randomized host list"
24213 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24214 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24215 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24216 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24217 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24218 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24219 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24220 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24222 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24223 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24224 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24225 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24227 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24229 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24230 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24231 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24233 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24234 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24235 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24236 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24237 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24238 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24239 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24240 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24241 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24244 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24245 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24246 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24247 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24248 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24251 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24252 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24253 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24254 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24255 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24256 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24257 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24258 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24261 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24262 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24263 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24264 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24265 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24267 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24268 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24269 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24270 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24271 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24272 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24274 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24275 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24276 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24277 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24278 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24279 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24280 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24282 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24283 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24284 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24285 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24286 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24287 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24288 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24291 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24292 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24293 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24294 If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24295 TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24296 If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24297 a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24298 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24299 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24302 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24303 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24304 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24305 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24306 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24307 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24308 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24309 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24310 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24311 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24313 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24314 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24316 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24317 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24318 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24319 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24320 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24322 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24323 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24324 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24325 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24326 for multi-recipient messages.
24327 The option can usually be left as default.
24329 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24330 .cindex "bind IP address"
24331 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24333 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24334 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24335 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24336 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24337 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24338 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24339 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24340 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24343 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24344 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24345 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24346 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24347 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24348 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24350 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24352 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24353 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24354 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24355 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24358 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24359 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24360 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24361 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24362 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24363 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24364 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24365 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24366 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24367 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24371 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24372 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24373 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24374 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24375 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24377 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24378 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24379 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24380 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24381 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24385 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24386 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24387 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24388 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24389 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24390 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24391 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24392 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24394 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24395 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24396 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24398 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24399 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24400 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24401 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24402 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24403 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24404 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24405 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24407 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24408 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24409 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
24410 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24415 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24416 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24417 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24418 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24420 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24421 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24422 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24423 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24424 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24426 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24427 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24428 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24429 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
24432 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24433 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24434 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24435 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24436 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24437 addresses is not affected.
24439 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24440 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24441 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24442 Exim to use only the host name.
24443 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24446 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24447 .cindex "serializing connections"
24448 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24449 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24450 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24451 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24452 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24453 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24454 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24456 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24457 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24458 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24459 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24460 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24461 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24463 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24464 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24465 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24466 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24467 are used for ETRN serialization.
24469 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24472 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24473 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24474 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24475 .cindex "size" "of message"
24476 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24477 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24478 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24479 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24480 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24481 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24482 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24483 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24485 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24486 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24489 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24490 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24491 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24492 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24495 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24496 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24497 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24499 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24500 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24501 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24502 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24503 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24506 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24507 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24508 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24509 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24513 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24514 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24515 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24516 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24517 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24520 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24521 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24522 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24523 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24524 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24525 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24528 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24531 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24532 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24534 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24535 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24536 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24537 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24538 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24539 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24540 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24541 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24544 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24545 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24546 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24548 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24549 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24550 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24551 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24552 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24553 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24554 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24555 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24556 ciphers is a preference order.
24560 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24561 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24562 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24563 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24564 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24565 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24566 certificate and private key for the session.
24568 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24570 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24576 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24577 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24578 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24579 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24580 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24581 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24582 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24583 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24584 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24585 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24589 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24590 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24591 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24592 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24593 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24594 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24595 Note that unless the host is in this list
24596 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24597 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24598 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24599 certificate verification succeeds.
24602 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24603 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24604 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24605 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24606 while verifying the server certificate,
24607 checks will be included on the host name
24608 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24609 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24610 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24612 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24615 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24616 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24617 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24619 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24620 The value of this option must be either the
24622 or the absolute path to
24623 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24624 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24626 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24627 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24628 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24631 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24632 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24634 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24636 either by file or directory
24637 are added to those given by the system default location.
24639 The values of &$host$& and
24640 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24641 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24643 For back-compatibility,
24644 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24645 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24646 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24649 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24650 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24651 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24652 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24653 certificate verification must succeed.
24654 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24655 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24656 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24661 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24663 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24664 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24665 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24666 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24667 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24670 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24671 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24672 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24673 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24676 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24677 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24678 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24680 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24681 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24682 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24683 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24684 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24686 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24687 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24688 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24689 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24690 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24691 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24692 see below for an exception).
24694 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24695 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24696 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24697 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24698 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24700 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24701 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24702 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24703 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24704 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24705 reached their retry times.
24707 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24708 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24709 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24710 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24711 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24712 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24713 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24714 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24715 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24716 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24719 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24720 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24721 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24722 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24723 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24724 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24726 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24727 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24728 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24729 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24730 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24731 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24737 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24740 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24741 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24742 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24743 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24744 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24745 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24747 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24748 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24749 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24750 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24751 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24752 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24753 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24755 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24756 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24757 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24758 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24761 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24762 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24763 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24764 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24766 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24767 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24768 facility; you do not have to use it.
24770 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24771 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24772 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24773 address to which it applies.
24775 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24776 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24777 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24778 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24779 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24780 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24783 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24784 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24785 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24786 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24789 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24790 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24791 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24792 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24793 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24796 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24797 illustrated by these examples:
24800 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24801 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24802 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24803 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24805 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24806 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24811 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24812 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24813 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24814 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24815 message's processing.
24817 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24818 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24819 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24820 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24821 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24822 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24823 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24824 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24825 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24827 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24828 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24829 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24830 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24831 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24832 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24833 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24834 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24835 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24836 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24838 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24839 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24840 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24841 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24842 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24843 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24845 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24846 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24847 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24849 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24850 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24851 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24852 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24853 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24854 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24855 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24856 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24857 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24859 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24860 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24866 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24867 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24868 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24869 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24870 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24871 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24872 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24873 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24874 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24875 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24877 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24879 might produce the output
24881 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24882 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24883 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24884 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24885 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24886 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24887 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24888 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24890 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24891 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24892 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24893 set for a particular transport.
24896 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24897 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24898 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24901 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24903 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24904 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24905 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24906 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24908 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24909 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24910 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24911 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24914 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24915 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24916 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24918 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24919 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24920 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24921 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24922 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24923 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24924 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24926 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24927 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24928 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24929 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24930 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24934 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24935 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24938 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24939 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24940 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24941 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24942 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24943 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24944 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24945 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24946 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24948 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24949 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24950 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24952 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24953 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24954 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24955 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24956 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24957 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24958 of pattern they are set as follows:
24961 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24962 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24963 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24966 *queen@*.fict.example
24968 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24970 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24974 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24975 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24978 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24979 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24980 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24981 rewriting rule of the form
24983 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24985 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24991 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24992 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24993 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24994 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24995 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24999 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25000 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25001 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25002 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25003 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25005 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25007 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25010 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25011 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25012 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25013 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25014 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25015 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25016 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25017 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25018 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25019 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25020 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25021 entry written to the panic log.
25025 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25026 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25029 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25032 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25034 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25037 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25038 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25042 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25044 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25045 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25046 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25047 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25048 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25049 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25051 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25052 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25053 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25054 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25055 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25056 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25057 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25058 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25059 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25060 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25062 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25063 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25064 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25066 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25067 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25070 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25071 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25072 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25073 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25074 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25075 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25076 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25077 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25078 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25080 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25081 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25082 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25083 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25084 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25085 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25086 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25087 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25090 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25091 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25092 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25093 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25096 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25097 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25098 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25100 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25101 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25102 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25103 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25105 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25106 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25107 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25109 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25110 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25111 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25112 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25114 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25118 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25121 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25122 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25123 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25124 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25125 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25126 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25127 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25128 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25130 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25131 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25135 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25136 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25138 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25139 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25140 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25142 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25143 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25144 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25145 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25146 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25147 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25148 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25149 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25151 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25152 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25154 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25156 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25157 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25159 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25160 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25161 messages that originate outside the local host:
25163 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25164 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25166 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25169 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25170 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25171 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25172 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25173 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25174 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25175 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25176 components. For example, the rule
25178 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25180 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25181 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25182 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25183 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25184 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25185 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25186 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25193 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25194 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25196 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25197 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25198 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25199 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25200 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25201 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25202 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25203 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25204 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25205 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25206 address, domain and error.
25208 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25209 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25210 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25211 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25212 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25213 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25214 log selector is set, the message
25215 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25216 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25217 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25218 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25220 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25221 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25222 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25223 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25224 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25225 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25226 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25227 domain are maintained independently.
25229 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25230 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25231 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25232 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25233 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25234 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25235 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25236 the local address is reached.
25238 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25239 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25240 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25241 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25242 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25244 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25245 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25246 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25247 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25248 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25249 messages that it should now be retaining.
25253 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25254 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25255 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25256 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25257 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25258 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25259 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25260 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25261 message's sender, respectively.
25264 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25265 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25266 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25267 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25268 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25269 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25272 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25274 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25277 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25279 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25280 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25283 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25284 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25285 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25286 expressions work in address lists.
25288 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25289 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25293 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25294 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25295 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25296 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25297 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25298 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25299 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25300 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25301 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25303 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25304 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25305 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25306 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25309 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25310 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25311 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25312 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25313 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25314 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25315 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25316 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25317 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25318 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25323 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25325 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25326 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25327 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25328 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25329 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25330 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25332 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25336 and the retry rules are
25338 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25339 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25341 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25342 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25343 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25344 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25345 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25346 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25348 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25349 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25350 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25351 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25353 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25354 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25355 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25357 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25359 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25360 textual form of the IP address.
25362 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25363 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25364 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25365 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25368 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25369 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25370 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25372 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25373 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25374 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25376 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25377 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25379 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25380 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25383 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25384 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25385 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25386 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25387 retry rule of this form:
25389 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25391 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25392 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25395 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25396 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25397 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25398 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25401 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25402 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25403 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25404 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25405 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25407 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25408 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25410 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25411 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25414 A connection was refused.
25416 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25417 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25419 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25420 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25422 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25423 A connection attempt timed out.
25425 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25426 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25427 obtained from an MX record.
25429 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25430 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25431 obtained from an MX record.
25434 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25436 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25437 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25438 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25439 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25442 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25445 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25446 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25447 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25448 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25449 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25450 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25454 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25455 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25456 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25457 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25458 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25462 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25463 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25464 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25466 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25467 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25468 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25469 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25470 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25471 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25472 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25474 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25475 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25478 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25479 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25480 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25485 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25486 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25487 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25488 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25489 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25492 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25494 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25496 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25498 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25499 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25502 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25504 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25505 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25506 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25507 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25508 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25510 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25511 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25513 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25515 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25516 list is never matched.
25522 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25523 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25524 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25525 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25527 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25529 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25530 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25531 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25532 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25533 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25535 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25536 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25537 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25538 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25539 The available algorithms are:
25542 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25545 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25546 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25547 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25549 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25550 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25551 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25552 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25553 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25554 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25555 queue processing times.
25558 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25559 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25560 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25561 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25562 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25563 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25564 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25565 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25566 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25567 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25568 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25569 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25571 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25572 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25573 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25574 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25575 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25576 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25579 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25580 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25581 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25582 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25583 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25584 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25585 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25586 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25587 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25588 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25589 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25590 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25592 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25593 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25594 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25595 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25596 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25597 deliveries that have been deferred.
25600 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25601 Here are some example retry rules:
25603 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25604 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25605 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25606 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25607 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
25608 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25610 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25611 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25612 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25613 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25614 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25615 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25616 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25619 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25620 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25621 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25622 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25623 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25625 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25626 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25627 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25628 were not obtained from an MX record.
25630 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25631 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25632 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25633 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25634 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25638 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25639 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25640 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25641 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25642 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25643 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25644 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25645 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25646 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25647 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25648 failing for the first time.
25650 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25651 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25652 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25653 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25655 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25656 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25657 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25662 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25663 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25664 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25665 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25666 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25667 default retry rule:
25669 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25671 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25672 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25673 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25675 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25676 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25677 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25678 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25679 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25681 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25682 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25683 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25685 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25686 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25687 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25688 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25689 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25690 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25691 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25692 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25694 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25695 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25696 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25697 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25698 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25701 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25702 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25703 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25704 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25705 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25706 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25707 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25708 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25709 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25712 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25713 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25714 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25715 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25716 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25717 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25718 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25719 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25722 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25723 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25724 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25725 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25726 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25727 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25728 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25729 time out the address.
25731 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25732 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25733 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25734 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25735 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25736 considered immediately.
25737 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25738 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25745 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25746 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25748 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25749 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25750 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25751 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25752 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25753 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25754 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25755 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25756 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25759 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25760 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25763 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25764 the client's EHLO command.
25766 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25767 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25769 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25770 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25771 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25772 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25773 with the AUTH command.
25775 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25777 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25778 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25779 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25782 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25783 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25784 unauthenticated connection.
25787 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25788 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25789 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25790 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25792 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25793 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25794 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25795 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
25796 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25797 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25798 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25799 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25804 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25805 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25806 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25807 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25808 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25809 included by setting
25812 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25815 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25820 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25821 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25822 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25823 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25824 work via a socket interface.
25825 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25826 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25827 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25828 supporting setting a server keytab.
25829 The sixth can be configured to support
25830 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25831 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25832 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25833 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25834 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25836 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25837 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25838 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25839 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25840 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25841 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25842 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25844 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25845 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25846 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25847 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25848 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25849 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25853 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25854 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25856 client_secret = secret2
25858 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25859 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25861 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25862 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25863 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25866 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25867 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25868 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25869 authenticating data.
25871 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25872 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25873 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25874 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25875 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25876 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25877 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25878 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25879 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25880 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25883 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25884 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25885 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25886 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25890 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25891 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25892 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25894 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25895 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25896 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25897 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25898 encrypted by a setting such as:
25900 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25904 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25905 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25906 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25907 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25910 .option driver authenticators string unset
25911 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25912 authenticators is to be used.
25915 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25916 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25917 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25918 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25919 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25920 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25923 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25924 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25925 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25926 mechanism is not advertised.
25927 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25928 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25929 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25932 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25933 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25934 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25937 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25938 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25940 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25941 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25942 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25943 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25944 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25945 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25946 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25947 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25948 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25952 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25953 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25954 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25955 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25956 out the values of variables.
25957 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25958 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25961 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25962 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25963 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25964 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25965 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25966 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25967 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25968 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25969 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25972 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25973 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25974 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25975 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25976 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25977 remembered for later use.
25978 How it is used is described in the following section.
25984 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25985 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25986 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25987 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25988 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25992 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25993 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25995 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25997 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25998 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25999 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26000 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26001 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26002 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26003 given for the MAIL command.
26005 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26006 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26009 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26010 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26011 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26012 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26013 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26014 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26015 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26020 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26021 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26022 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26023 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26025 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26026 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26027 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26028 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26029 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26034 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26035 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26036 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26037 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26041 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26043 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26044 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26047 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26048 the mechanisms are advertised.
26050 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26051 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26052 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26053 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26054 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26055 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26056 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26058 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26060 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26062 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26063 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26064 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26067 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26069 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26070 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26071 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26073 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26074 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26075 command. This is the case if
26078 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26080 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26082 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26083 server authenticators.
26087 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26088 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26089 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26091 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26092 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26093 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26094 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26095 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26096 rejected with a 504 error.
26098 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26099 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26100 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26101 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26102 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26103 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26104 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26105 no successful authentication.
26110 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26111 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26112 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26113 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26114 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26115 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26116 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26120 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26122 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26123 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26124 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26125 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26126 command line to run this script on such data might be
26128 encode '\0user\0password'
26130 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26131 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26132 whose code value is zero.
26134 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26135 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26136 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26137 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26139 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26140 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26141 example, a command such as
26143 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26145 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26147 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26148 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26150 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26152 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26153 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26154 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26155 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26159 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26160 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26161 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26162 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26163 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26164 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26167 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26168 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26169 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26170 of the authenticator.
26173 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26174 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26175 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26176 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26177 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26178 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26179 delivery to be deferred.
26181 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26182 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26183 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26186 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26187 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26188 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26189 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26190 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26191 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26192 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26193 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26194 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26197 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26198 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26199 on and the transport running. For example, with a manualroute
26200 router given a host name, and DNS "round-robin" use by that name: if
26201 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26202 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26203 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26204 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26206 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26208 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26209 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26210 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26211 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26212 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26213 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26214 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26215 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26216 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26217 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26218 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26219 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26220 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26227 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26228 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26230 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26231 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26232 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26233 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26234 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26235 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26236 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26237 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26238 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26239 connections as you do for login accounts.
26241 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26242 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26243 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26245 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26246 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26247 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26249 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26250 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26251 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26254 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26255 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26256 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26257 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26258 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26259 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26260 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26262 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26263 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26264 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26265 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26266 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26267 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26268 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26270 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26271 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26272 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26273 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26275 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26276 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26277 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26279 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26280 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26281 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26282 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26283 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26284 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26285 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26286 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26287 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26288 string as the error text
26290 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26291 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26292 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26296 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26297 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26298 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26299 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26300 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26301 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26302 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26303 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26305 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26306 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26307 configured as follows:
26311 public_name = PLAIN
26313 server_condition = \
26314 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26315 server_set_id = $auth2
26317 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26318 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26319 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26320 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26322 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26323 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26324 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26325 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26329 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26331 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26333 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26334 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26338 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26339 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26341 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26342 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26343 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26344 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26345 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26347 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26348 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26349 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26351 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26352 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26353 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26354 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26355 This is an incorrect example:
26357 server_condition = \
26358 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26360 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26361 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26362 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26363 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26364 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26365 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26366 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26368 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26369 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26371 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26372 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26373 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26374 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26375 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26378 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26379 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26380 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26381 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26382 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26383 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26384 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26388 public_name = LOGIN
26389 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26390 server_condition = \
26391 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26392 server_set_id = $auth1
26394 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26395 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26396 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26397 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26399 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26400 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26401 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26402 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26403 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26407 public_name = LOGIN
26408 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26409 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26412 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26413 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26414 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26415 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26417 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26418 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26419 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26420 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26421 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26422 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26423 uninterpreted string.
26426 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26427 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26428 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26429 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26430 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26436 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26437 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26438 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26440 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26441 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26442 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26443 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26446 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26447 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26448 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26449 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26450 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26451 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26452 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26453 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26454 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26455 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26456 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26457 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26459 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26460 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26462 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26463 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26464 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26465 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26468 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26469 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26473 public_name = PLAIN
26474 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26476 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26477 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26478 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26482 public_name = LOGIN
26483 client_send = : username : mysecret
26485 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26486 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26488 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26489 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26494 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26495 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26497 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26498 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26499 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26500 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26501 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26502 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26503 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26504 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26505 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26506 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26507 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26508 available in plain text at either end.
26511 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26512 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26513 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26514 authenticator as a server:
26516 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26517 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26518 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26519 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26520 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26521 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26522 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26523 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26524 returned to the client.
26526 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26527 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26528 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26529 numeric variables for other things.
26531 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26532 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26533 user name, authentication fails.
26537 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26538 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26539 server_set_id = $auth1
26541 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26542 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26543 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26544 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26548 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26549 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26551 server_set_id = $auth1
26553 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26554 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26556 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26557 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26558 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26563 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26564 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26565 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26566 server_set_id = $auth1
26569 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26570 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26571 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26575 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26576 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26577 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26580 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26581 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26582 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26586 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26587 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26588 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26589 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26590 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26591 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26592 send the message to the current server.
26594 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26599 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26601 client_secret = secret
26603 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
26604 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
26608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26609 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26611 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26612 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26613 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26614 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26616 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26617 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26619 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26620 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26621 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26622 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26623 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26625 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26626 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26627 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26628 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26630 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26631 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26632 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26633 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26634 depending on the driver you are using.
26636 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26637 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26638 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26639 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26640 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26643 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26644 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26645 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26646 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26647 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26648 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26649 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26650 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26653 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26654 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26655 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26656 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26657 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26658 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26662 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26663 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26664 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26665 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26668 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26669 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26670 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26671 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26675 driver = cyrus_sasl
26676 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26677 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26678 server_set_id = $auth1
26681 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26682 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26685 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26686 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26689 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26690 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26691 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26692 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26695 driver = cyrus_sasl
26696 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26697 server_set_id = $auth1
26700 driver = cyrus_sasl
26701 public_name = PLAIN
26702 server_set_id = $auth2
26704 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26705 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26706 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26707 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26708 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26713 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26714 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26715 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26716 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26717 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26718 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26719 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26720 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26721 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26722 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26723 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26725 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26727 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26728 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26729 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26730 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26734 public_name = PLAIN
26735 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26736 server_set_id = $auth1
26741 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26742 server_set_id = $auth1
26744 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26745 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26746 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26747 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26748 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26749 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26750 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26751 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26754 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26755 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26756 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26757 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26758 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26759 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26760 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26761 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26762 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26763 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26764 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26765 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26766 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26767 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26768 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26769 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26770 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26771 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26772 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26773 without code changes in Exim.
26776 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26777 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26778 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26779 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26780 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26783 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26784 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26785 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26787 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26788 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26789 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26791 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26792 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26793 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26796 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26797 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26798 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26799 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26802 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26803 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26804 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26805 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26810 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26811 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26812 server_set_id = $auth1
26816 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26817 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26818 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26819 the password itself.
26821 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26822 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26823 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26824 if available, else the empty string.
26825 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26826 else the empty string.
26828 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26830 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26831 option to be simply "true".
26834 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26835 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26836 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26839 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26840 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26841 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26842 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26845 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26846 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26847 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26848 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26851 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26852 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26853 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26856 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26857 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26858 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26859 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26861 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26862 meanings for these variables:
26865 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26866 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26868 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26869 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26871 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26872 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26875 On a per-mechanism basis:
26878 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26879 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26880 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26882 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26883 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26884 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26886 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26887 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26888 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26889 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26892 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26893 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26894 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26897 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26898 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26900 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26902 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26903 server_realm = imap.example.org
26904 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26905 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26906 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26907 server_condition = yes
26911 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26912 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26914 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26915 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26916 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26917 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26918 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26919 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26920 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26923 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26924 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26925 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26926 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26928 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26929 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26930 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26931 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26933 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26934 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26935 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26939 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26940 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26941 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26942 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26944 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26945 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26946 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26947 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26949 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26951 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26952 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26954 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26955 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26956 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26961 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26962 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26964 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26965 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26966 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26967 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26968 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26969 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26970 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26971 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26972 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26973 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26974 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26975 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26976 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26980 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26981 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26983 The server sends back a challenge.
26985 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26986 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26989 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26993 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26994 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26995 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26997 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26998 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26999 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27000 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27001 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27002 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27003 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27004 for other things. For example:
27009 server_password = \
27010 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27012 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27013 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27019 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27020 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27021 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27025 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27026 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27029 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27030 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27033 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27034 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27035 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27041 client_username = msn/msn_username
27042 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27043 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27045 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27046 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27052 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27053 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27055 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27056 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27057 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27058 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27059 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27060 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27061 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27062 authentication based on client certificates.
27064 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27065 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27066 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27067 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27068 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27069 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27071 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27072 for which it must have been requested via the
27073 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27074 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27076 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27077 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27078 and can authenticate the connection.
27079 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27081 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27084 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27085 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27087 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27088 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27089 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27090 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27091 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27092 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27094 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27095 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27096 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27098 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27105 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27106 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27107 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
27109 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27110 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27111 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27113 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27115 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27116 of your configured trust-anchors
27117 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27118 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27119 Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27120 whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27122 . An alternative might use
27124 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27126 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27127 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27128 . This would help for per-device use.
27130 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27131 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27133 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27134 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27137 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27138 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27139 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27143 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27144 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27146 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27147 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27148 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27149 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27150 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27153 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27154 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27155 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27156 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27157 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27158 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27159 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27160 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27161 certificates are used.
27163 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27164 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27165 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27166 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27167 between them is encrypted.
27169 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27170 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27171 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27172 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27175 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27176 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27177 in order to get TLS to work.
27181 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27183 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27184 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27185 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27186 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27187 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27188 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27189 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27190 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27191 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27192 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27193 in preference to STARTTLS.
27195 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27196 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27197 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27199 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27200 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27201 reassigned for other use.
27202 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27204 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only supported submissions, not
27205 submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27206 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27208 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27209 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27210 the most common use is expected to be:
27212 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27214 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27215 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27216 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27217 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27218 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27221 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27222 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27229 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27230 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27231 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27232 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27233 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27237 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27241 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27242 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27244 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27247 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27248 cannot be the path of a directory
27249 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27250 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27252 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27254 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27255 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27256 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27257 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27258 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27260 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27261 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27262 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27263 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27264 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27265 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27266 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27269 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27270 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27272 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27273 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27274 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27275 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27277 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27278 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27280 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27281 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27282 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27283 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27287 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27288 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27289 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27290 but not the chosen filename.
27291 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27292 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27294 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27295 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27296 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27297 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27299 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27300 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27301 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27302 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27303 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27304 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27305 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27307 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27308 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27309 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27310 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27311 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27313 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27314 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27315 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27316 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27317 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27318 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27320 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27321 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27322 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27324 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27325 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27326 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27327 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27330 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27333 # chown exim:exim new-params
27334 # chmod 0600 new-params
27335 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27336 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27337 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27338 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27339 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27340 # chmod 0400 new-params
27341 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27343 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27344 stalling is removed.
27346 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27347 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27348 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27349 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27350 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27351 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27352 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27353 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27354 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27355 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27356 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27358 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27359 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27360 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27361 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27363 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27364 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27365 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27366 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27367 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27370 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27371 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27372 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27373 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27374 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27375 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27376 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27377 directly to this function call.
27378 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27379 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27380 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27381 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27384 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27386 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27387 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27388 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27391 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27392 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27393 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27397 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27400 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27401 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27404 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27405 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27407 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27408 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27411 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27412 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27413 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27414 not be moved to the end of the list.
27417 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27420 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27421 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27424 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27425 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27426 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27427 choice of clients used:
27429 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27430 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27435 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27437 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
27441 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27443 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27444 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27445 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27446 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27447 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27448 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27449 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27450 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27451 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27452 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27454 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27455 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27457 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27458 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27459 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27460 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27461 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27462 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27464 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27465 "Priority strings". This is online as
27466 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27467 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27468 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27469 then the example code
27470 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27471 on that site can be used to test a given string.
27475 # Disable older versions of protocols
27476 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27479 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27480 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27481 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27483 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27484 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27485 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27486 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27490 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27496 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27497 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27498 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27499 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27500 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27501 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27502 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27504 If STARTTLS is to be used you
27505 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27507 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27508 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27509 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27512 554 Security failure
27514 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27515 rejected with a 554 error code.
27517 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27518 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27520 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27521 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27522 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27523 from someone able to intercept the communication.
27525 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27527 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
27529 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27530 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27532 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27533 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27534 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27535 that goes with it. These files need to be
27536 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27537 always be given as full path names.
27538 The key must not be password-protected.
27539 They can be the same file if both the
27540 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27541 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27542 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27543 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27544 the server's certificate.
27546 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
27547 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
27548 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
27549 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
27550 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
27551 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
27553 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27554 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27555 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27557 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27558 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27559 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27562 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27563 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27564 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27566 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27568 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27569 with the parameters contained in the file.
27570 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27575 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27576 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27577 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27578 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27584 for a way of generating file data.
27586 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27587 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27588 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27589 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27590 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27592 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27593 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27594 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27595 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27596 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27597 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27598 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27599 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27600 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27602 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27603 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27604 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27605 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27606 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27607 documentation for more details.
27609 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27610 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27613 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27614 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27615 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27616 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27617 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27618 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27619 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27620 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27621 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27622 expected certificates.
27623 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27624 an explicit file or,
27625 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27626 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27628 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27631 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27632 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27633 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27635 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27637 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27639 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27640 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27641 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27642 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27643 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27644 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27645 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27646 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27647 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27648 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27650 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27651 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27652 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27653 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27655 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27656 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27657 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27658 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27659 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27660 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27663 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27664 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27665 .cindex "revocation list"
27666 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27667 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27668 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27669 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27670 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27671 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27672 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27674 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27675 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27677 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27678 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27679 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27680 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27681 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27682 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27684 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27685 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27686 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27687 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27689 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27690 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27691 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27692 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27693 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27694 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27695 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27696 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27698 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27699 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27700 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27702 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27703 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27704 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27705 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27706 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27708 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27709 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27710 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27711 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27712 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27715 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27716 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27719 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27720 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27721 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27722 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27723 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27724 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27726 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27727 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27729 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27732 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27733 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27734 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27736 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27737 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27738 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27744 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27745 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27746 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27747 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27748 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27749 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27750 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27751 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27752 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27754 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27755 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27756 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27757 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27758 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27760 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27761 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27762 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27763 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27764 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27767 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27768 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27769 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27770 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27771 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27772 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27773 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27774 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27775 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27776 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27779 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27780 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27781 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27782 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27784 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27785 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27787 the system default set (depending on library version),
27789 or (depending on library version) a directory.
27790 The client verifies the server's certificate
27791 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27792 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27793 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27794 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27796 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27797 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27798 or need not succeed respectively.
27800 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27801 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27802 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27804 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27805 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27806 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27809 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27810 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27811 for OCSP to be relevant.
27814 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27815 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27816 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27817 alternative hosts, if any.
27820 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27821 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27822 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27826 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27827 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27828 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27829 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27830 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27832 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27833 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27834 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27835 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27836 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27837 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27838 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27839 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27840 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27841 outgoing connection.
27845 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27846 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27847 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27848 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27849 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27850 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27851 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27852 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27853 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27854 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27857 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27858 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27861 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27862 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27863 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27864 be of limited use in that environment.
27866 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27867 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27868 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27869 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27870 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27872 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27873 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27874 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27875 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27876 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27878 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27879 received from a client.
27880 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27882 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27883 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27884 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27887 &%tls_certificate%&
27893 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27898 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27899 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27900 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
27901 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27902 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
27903 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
27904 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
27906 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27909 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27910 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27911 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27912 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27914 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27915 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27916 built, then you have SNI support).
27920 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27922 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27923 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27924 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27925 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27926 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27927 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27928 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27929 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
27930 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
27931 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
27933 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
27934 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
27935 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
27936 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
27937 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27938 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27939 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27941 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27942 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27943 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27944 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27945 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27946 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27947 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27948 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27949 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27951 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27952 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27953 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27954 information is recorded.
27956 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27957 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27958 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27963 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27964 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27965 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27966 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27967 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27968 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27969 to Apache, currently at
27971 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27973 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27974 links to further files.
27975 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27976 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27977 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27979 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27983 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27984 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27985 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27986 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27987 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27988 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27989 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27990 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27991 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27992 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27993 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27994 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27995 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27997 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27998 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27999 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28000 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28004 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28005 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28006 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28007 with OpenSSL, like this:
28008 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28009 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28011 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28014 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28015 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28016 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28017 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28018 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28019 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28020 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28022 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28023 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28024 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28025 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28026 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28027 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28029 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28030 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28031 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28032 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28033 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28034 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28035 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28036 be a sensible resolution).
28038 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28039 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28040 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28042 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28043 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28044 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28045 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28046 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28047 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28049 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28050 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28051 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28052 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
28053 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28054 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28059 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28061 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28062 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28063 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28064 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28065 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28066 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28068 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28069 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28070 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28072 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28073 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28075 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28076 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28077 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28079 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28080 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28081 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28083 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28084 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is traceable to the one
28085 defined by (one of?) the TSLA records
28087 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28088 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28089 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28090 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28092 The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3). The latter specifies
28093 the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server (and should be the sole one transmitted
28094 during the TLS handshake); this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28095 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28096 well-known one. A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate which is used to sign
28097 cerver certificates, but running one securely does require careful arrangement. If a private CA is used
28098 then either all clients must be primed with it, or (probably simpler) the server TLS handshake must transmit
28099 the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate. If a public CA is used then all clients must be primed with it
28100 (losing one advantage of DANE) - but the attack surface is reduced from all public CAs to that single CA.
28101 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28102 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28104 The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28106 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28107 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28110 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28111 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28116 are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28118 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28120 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28121 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28122 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28125 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28126 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28130 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28131 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28132 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28133 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28134 control the OCSP request.
28136 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28137 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28140 For client-side DANE there are two new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%& and &%hosts_require_dane%&.
28141 The latter variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28143 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28145 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28146 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28147 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28148 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28150 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28154 tls_try_verify_hosts
28155 tls_verify_certificates
28157 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28160 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28161 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28163 Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28165 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28167 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28168 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28169 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28170 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28172 .cindex DANE reporting
28173 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28174 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28175 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28176 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28177 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28178 Section 4.3 of that document.
28180 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28185 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28186 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28188 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28189 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28190 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
28191 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28192 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28193 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
28194 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28195 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28196 one very small ACL:
28200 accept hosts = one.host.only
28202 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28203 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28205 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28206 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28207 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28208 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28209 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28210 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28211 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28212 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28215 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28216 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28217 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28220 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28221 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28222 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28223 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28224 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28225 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28226 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28227 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28228 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28229 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28230 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28231 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28232 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28233 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28234 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28235 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28236 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28237 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28238 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28239 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28242 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28243 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28244 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28245 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28246 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28247 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28248 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28249 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28250 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28251 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28252 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28253 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28254 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28255 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28256 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28257 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28258 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28259 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28260 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28261 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28264 For example, if you set
28266 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28268 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28269 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28270 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28271 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28272 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28273 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28274 testing as possible at RCPT time.
28277 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28278 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28279 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28280 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28281 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28282 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28283 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28284 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28285 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28286 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28287 in any of these ACLs.
28289 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28290 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28291 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28292 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28293 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28294 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28295 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28296 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28298 control = suppress_local_fixups
28300 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28301 run, it is too late.
28303 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28304 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28306 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28307 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28308 temporary error for these kinds of message.
28311 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28312 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28313 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28314 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28315 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28316 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28317 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28318 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28319 &%smtp_banner%& option.
28322 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28323 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28324 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28325 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28326 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28327 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28328 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28329 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28330 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28332 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28333 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28334 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28336 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28337 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28338 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28339 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28343 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28344 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28345 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28346 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28347 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28348 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28349 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28350 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28351 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28352 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28354 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28355 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28356 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
28357 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
28358 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
28359 associated with the DATA command.
28361 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
28362 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
28363 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
28364 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
28365 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
28366 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
28367 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
28368 the data specified is received.
28370 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
28371 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
28372 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
28373 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
28374 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
28377 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
28378 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
28379 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
28380 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
28382 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
28383 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
28384 enabled (which is the default).
28386 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
28387 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
28388 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
28390 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28392 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
28395 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
28396 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28397 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28399 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28402 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
28403 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28404 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28405 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28406 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28407 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28408 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28411 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28412 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28413 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28414 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28415 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28416 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28417 for some or all recipients.
28419 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28420 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28421 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28422 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28423 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28425 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28426 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28427 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28429 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28430 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28432 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28433 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28434 the feature was not requested by the client.
28436 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28437 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28438 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28439 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28440 does not in fact control any access.
28441 For this reason, it may only accept
28442 or warn as its final result.
28444 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28445 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28446 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28447 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28449 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28450 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28452 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28453 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28456 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28457 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28458 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28459 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28460 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28463 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28464 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28465 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28466 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28467 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28468 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28469 situation even worse.
28471 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28472 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28473 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28476 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28477 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28478 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28479 connection. The possible values are:
28481 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28482 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28483 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28484 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28485 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28486 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28487 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28488 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28489 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28490 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28492 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28493 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28494 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28495 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28496 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28500 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28501 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28502 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28503 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28505 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28506 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28508 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28509 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
28510 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28511 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28512 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28514 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28515 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28516 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28519 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28520 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28521 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28522 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28523 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28524 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28526 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28527 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28528 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28530 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28531 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28532 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28533 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28535 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28536 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28537 matches the string.
28539 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28540 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28541 want to have something like
28543 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28545 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28546 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28552 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28553 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28554 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28555 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28556 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28557 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28558 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28559 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28560 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28562 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28563 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28564 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28567 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28568 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28569 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28570 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28572 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28573 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28574 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28575 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28576 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28577 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28578 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28580 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28581 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28584 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28585 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28586 recipients; it may create new recipients.
28590 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28591 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28592 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28593 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28594 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28595 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28597 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28598 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28599 used to accept or reject anything.
28601 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28602 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28603 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28604 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28606 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28607 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28608 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28609 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28610 configuration file.
28615 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28616 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28618 .vindex &$local_part$&
28619 .vindex &$sender_address$&
28620 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28621 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28622 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28623 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28624 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28625 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28626 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28627 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28629 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28630 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28631 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28634 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
28635 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28636 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28637 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28638 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28641 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28642 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28643 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28644 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28645 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28646 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28647 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28648 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28654 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28655 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28656 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28657 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28658 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28659 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28660 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28661 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28662 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28663 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28664 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28665 unencrypted connections.
28668 accept encrypted = *
28669 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28671 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28673 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28674 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28675 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28676 option to do this.)
28680 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28681 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28682 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28683 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28684 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28685 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28686 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28688 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28689 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28690 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28693 deny dnslists = list1.example
28694 dnslists = list2.example
28696 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28697 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28698 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28699 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28700 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28703 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28704 The ACL verbs are as follows:
28707 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28708 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28709 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28710 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28711 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28712 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28713 check a RCPT command:
28715 accept domains = +local_domains
28719 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28720 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28721 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28722 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28725 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28726 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28727 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28730 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28731 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28732 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28733 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28734 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28735 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28737 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28738 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28740 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28741 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28742 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28744 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28745 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28746 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28751 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28752 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28753 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28754 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28755 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28756 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28757 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28761 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28762 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28763 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28766 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28768 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28772 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28773 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28774 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28775 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28776 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28777 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28778 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28779 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28780 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28782 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28783 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28784 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28788 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28789 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28790 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28792 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28793 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28795 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28796 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28799 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28800 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28801 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28802 example, when checking a RCPT command,
28804 require message = Sender did not verify
28807 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28808 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28809 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28810 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28813 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28814 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28815 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28816 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28817 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28818 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28819 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28821 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28822 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28823 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28824 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28825 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28827 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28828 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28829 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28830 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28831 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28832 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28836 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28837 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28838 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28839 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28841 warn !verify = sender
28842 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28846 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28848 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28849 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28850 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28851 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28852 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28856 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28857 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28858 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28859 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28860 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28861 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28862 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28863 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28864 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28865 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28867 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28868 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28869 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28870 on the same SMTP connection.
28872 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28873 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28874 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28877 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28878 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28879 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28881 accept hosts = whatever
28882 set acl_m4 = some value
28883 accept authenticated = *
28884 set acl_c_auth = yes
28886 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28887 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28888 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28890 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28891 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28892 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28893 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28894 error is generated.
28896 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28897 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28900 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28901 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28902 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28903 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28905 deny domains = *.dom.example
28906 !verify = recipient
28908 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28909 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28910 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28911 two statements are equivalent:
28913 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28914 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28916 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28917 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28919 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28920 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28921 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28923 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28924 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28925 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28926 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28928 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28929 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28930 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28931 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28932 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28933 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28934 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28936 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28937 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28938 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
28939 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28940 message is handled.
28942 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28943 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28944 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28945 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28947 require message = Can't verify sender
28949 message = Can't verify recipient
28951 message = This message cannot be used
28953 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
28954 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
28955 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
28956 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
28957 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
28958 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
28960 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
28961 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
28962 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
28963 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
28966 !senders = *@my.domain.example
28967 message = Invalid sender from client host
28969 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
28970 by which time Exim has set up the message.
28974 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
28975 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
28976 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
28979 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28980 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
28981 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28982 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28984 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28985 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28986 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28987 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28988 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28989 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28990 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28991 write rather ugly lines like this:
28993 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28995 Instead, all you need is
28997 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29000 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29001 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29002 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29003 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29004 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29005 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29006 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29007 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29009 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29010 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29011 in several different ways. For example:
29013 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29014 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29015 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29019 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29021 accept ...some conditions
29022 control = queue_only
29024 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29025 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29028 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29030 accept ...some conditions...
29031 control = queue_only
29032 ...some more conditions...
29034 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29035 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29036 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29040 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29041 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29044 warn ...some conditions...
29048 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29049 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29053 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29054 &%require%& verb. For example:
29056 require control = no_multiline_responses
29060 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29061 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29063 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29064 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29065 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29066 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29067 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29068 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29070 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29073 deny ...some conditions...
29076 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29077 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29080 ...some conditions...
29082 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29083 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29085 warn ...some conditions...
29091 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29092 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29093 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29094 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29095 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29096 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29097 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29101 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29102 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29103 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29104 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29105 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29106 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29107 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29110 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29111 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29112 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29113 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29115 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29116 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29118 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29121 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29122 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29124 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29125 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29126 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29129 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29130 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29131 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29132 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29133 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29134 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29137 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29138 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29139 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29142 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29143 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29144 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29145 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29146 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29147 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29149 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29150 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29151 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29152 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29153 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29154 logging rejections.
29157 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29158 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29159 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29160 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29161 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29162 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29163 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29164 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29166 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29167 &` log_reject_target =`&
29169 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29170 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29174 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29175 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29176 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29177 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29178 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29179 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29180 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29183 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29184 &` control = freeze`&
29185 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29187 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29188 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29189 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29192 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29193 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29197 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29198 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29199 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29200 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29201 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29202 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29203 &%accept%& for details.)
29205 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29206 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29207 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29208 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29209 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29211 require message = Host not recognized
29214 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29217 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29218 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29219 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29220 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29221 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29222 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29223 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29224 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29225 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29228 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29229 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29230 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29232 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29233 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29235 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29236 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29237 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
29240 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29241 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29243 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29244 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29245 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29248 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29249 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29250 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29252 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29253 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29254 However, the original message is available in the variable
29255 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29256 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29257 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29258 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29260 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29261 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29262 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29263 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29264 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29265 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29269 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29270 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29271 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29272 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29274 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29276 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29277 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29278 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29279 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29282 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29283 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29284 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29285 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29288 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29289 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29290 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29291 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29294 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29295 .cindex "UDP communications"
29296 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29297 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29298 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29299 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29300 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29301 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29302 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29305 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29306 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29313 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29314 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29315 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29318 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29319 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29320 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29321 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29322 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29323 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29324 not work without it. For example:
29326 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29327 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29329 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29330 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29331 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29332 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29333 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29336 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29337 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29338 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29339 .cindex "case of local parts"
29340 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29341 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29342 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29343 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29344 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29345 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29348 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29349 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29350 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29351 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29352 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29354 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29355 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29358 warn control = caseful_local_part
29359 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
29361 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
29363 control = caselower_local_part
29365 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
29366 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
29369 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
29370 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
29371 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
29372 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
29374 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
29375 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
29376 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
29377 is used for all recipients of the message,
29378 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
29379 and data is copied from one to the other.
29381 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
29382 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
29383 If a recipient-verify callout
29385 connection is subsequently
29386 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
29387 any subsequent recipients and the data,
29388 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
29390 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
29391 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
29392 Note also that headers cannot be
29393 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
29394 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
29395 The Received-By: header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
29396 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
29397 this will affect the timestamp.
29399 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
29400 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
29401 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
29402 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
29405 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
29406 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
29407 before the entire message has been received from the source.
29408 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
29412 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29413 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29414 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29415 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29416 before the acceptance "<=" line.
29418 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29420 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29421 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29422 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29423 and does not queue the message.
29424 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29426 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29428 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29431 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29432 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29433 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29434 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29435 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29436 by default called &'debuglog'&.
29437 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29438 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29439 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29441 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29442 with the &'kill'& option.
29443 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29447 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29448 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29449 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29450 control = debug/kill
29454 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29455 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29456 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29457 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29458 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29461 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29462 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29463 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29464 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29465 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29466 strings or to numeric value.
29467 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29468 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29469 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29471 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29472 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29473 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29474 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29475 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29478 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29479 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29480 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29481 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29482 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29483 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29484 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29485 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29487 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29488 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29489 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29490 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29491 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29492 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29496 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29497 .cindex "fake defer"
29498 .cindex "defer, fake"
29499 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29500 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29501 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29502 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29503 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29505 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29506 .cindex "fake rejection"
29507 .cindex "rejection, fake"
29508 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29509 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29510 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29511 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29512 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29513 the same SMTP connection.
29515 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29516 message is supplied, the following is used:
29518 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29519 550-kept for evaluation.
29520 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29521 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29523 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29525 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29526 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29527 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29528 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29529 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29530 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29533 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29534 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29535 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29536 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29538 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29539 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29540 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29541 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29542 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29543 disables such output flushing.
29545 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29546 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29547 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29548 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29549 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29550 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29552 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29553 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29554 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29555 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29556 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29557 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29558 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29559 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29560 to be useful in production.
29562 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29563 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29564 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29565 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29566 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29568 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29569 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29570 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29571 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29572 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29573 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29576 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29577 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29578 verification failed"&) is sent.
29580 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29584 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29585 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29587 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29588 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29589 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29590 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29591 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29592 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29593 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29595 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29596 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29597 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29598 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29599 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29600 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29601 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29602 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29603 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29604 same SMTP connection.
29606 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29607 .cindex "message" "submission"
29608 .cindex "submission mode"
29609 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29610 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29611 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29612 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29613 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29614 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29615 late (the message has already been created).
29617 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29618 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29619 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29620 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29621 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29623 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29624 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29625 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29626 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29627 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29630 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29631 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29633 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29635 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29638 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29639 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29640 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29641 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29644 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29645 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29647 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29648 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29650 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29654 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29655 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29658 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29660 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29661 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29663 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29665 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29670 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29671 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29672 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29673 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29674 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29675 to an incoming message, as in this example:
29677 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29678 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29679 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29681 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29682 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29683 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29684 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
29685 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29688 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29689 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29691 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29692 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29693 contains one or more newlines that
29694 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29695 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29696 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29698 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29699 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29700 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29701 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29702 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29703 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29704 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29705 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29706 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29707 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29708 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29710 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29711 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29713 until they are added to the
29714 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29715 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29716 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29717 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29718 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29719 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29720 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29722 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29724 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29725 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29727 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29728 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29730 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29731 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29733 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29734 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29735 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29736 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29739 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29740 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29741 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29742 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29743 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29744 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29745 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29748 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29749 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29750 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29751 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29752 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29754 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29755 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29756 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29757 to be a header name first.) For example:
29759 warn add_header = \
29760 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29762 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29763 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29764 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29765 up in reverse order.
29767 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29768 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29769 system filter or in a router or transport.
29773 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29774 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29775 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29776 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29777 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29778 from an incoming message, as in this example:
29780 warn message = Remove internal headers
29781 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29783 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29784 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29785 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29786 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29787 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29788 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29790 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
29791 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29793 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29794 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29795 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29796 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29797 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29799 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29800 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29801 warn message = Remove internal headers
29802 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29804 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29805 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29806 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29807 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29808 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29809 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29810 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29811 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29812 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29813 would have been removed.
29815 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29816 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29817 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29818 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29819 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29820 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29821 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29822 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29823 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29825 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29826 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29828 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29829 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29831 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29832 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29834 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29835 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29836 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29837 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29840 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29841 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29842 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29847 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29848 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29849 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29850 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29851 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29852 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29854 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29855 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29856 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29857 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29858 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29859 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29860 The conditions are as follows:
29864 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29865 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29866 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29867 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29868 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29869 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29870 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29871 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29872 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29873 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29874 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29875 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29877 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29878 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29879 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29880 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29881 The name and values are expanded separately.
29882 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29883 will act as argument separators.
29885 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29886 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29887 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29888 conditions are tested.
29890 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29891 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29892 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29893 for different local users or different local domains.
29895 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29896 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29897 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29898 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29899 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29900 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29901 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29906 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29907 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29908 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29909 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29910 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29911 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29912 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29913 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29914 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29915 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29916 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29917 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29920 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29921 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29922 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29923 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29924 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29925 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29926 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29927 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29929 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29930 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29931 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29932 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29933 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29934 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29935 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29936 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29937 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29938 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
29940 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29941 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
29942 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
29943 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
29944 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
29945 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
29946 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
29947 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
29948 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
29951 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
29952 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
29955 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29956 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
29957 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
29958 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
29959 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
29960 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
29961 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
29967 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
29968 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
29969 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
29970 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
29971 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
29972 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
29973 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
29975 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29977 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
29978 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
29979 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
29981 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
29982 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
29983 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
29984 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
29985 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
29986 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
29988 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
29989 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
29991 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29992 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
29994 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
29995 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
29996 statement can then check the IP address.
29998 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
29999 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30000 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30001 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30003 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30004 message = $host_data
30006 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30008 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30009 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30010 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30011 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30012 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30013 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30014 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30015 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30016 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30017 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30019 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30020 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30021 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30022 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30023 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30024 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30025 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30027 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30028 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30029 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30030 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30031 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30032 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30033 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30036 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30037 .cindex "rate limiting"
30038 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30039 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30041 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30042 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30043 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30044 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30045 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30046 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30048 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30049 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30050 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30051 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30052 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30053 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30054 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30056 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30057 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30058 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30059 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30060 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30061 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30062 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30063 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30064 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30065 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30066 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30067 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30068 influence the sender checking.
30070 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30071 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30073 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30074 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30075 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30076 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30077 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30078 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30082 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30083 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30085 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30086 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30087 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30088 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30089 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30090 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30092 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30093 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30094 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30095 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30096 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30097 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30098 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30099 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30100 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30101 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30103 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30104 .cindex "CSA verification"
30105 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30106 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30107 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30109 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30110 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30111 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30112 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30113 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30114 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30115 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30116 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30117 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30118 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30120 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30121 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30122 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30124 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30125 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30126 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30127 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30128 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30129 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30130 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30131 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30132 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30133 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30134 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30135 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30136 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30137 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30138 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30140 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30141 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30142 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30143 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30146 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30147 !verify = header_sender
30150 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30151 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30152 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30153 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30154 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30155 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30156 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30157 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30158 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30159 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30160 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30161 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30162 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30165 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30166 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30170 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30171 common as they used to be.
30173 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30174 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30175 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30176 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30177 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30178 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30179 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30180 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30181 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30182 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30183 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30184 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30185 independently of this condition.
30187 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30188 option), this condition is always true.
30191 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
30192 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30193 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30194 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30195 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30196 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30197 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30198 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30199 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30201 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30202 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30205 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30206 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30207 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30208 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30209 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30210 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30211 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30212 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30213 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30214 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30215 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30216 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30217 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30218 value for the child address.
30220 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30221 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30222 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30223 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30224 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30225 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30226 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30227 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30228 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30229 original IP address.
30231 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30232 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30234 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30235 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30237 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30238 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30239 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30240 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
30241 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
30242 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30243 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30244 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30245 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30247 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30248 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30249 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30250 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30251 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30252 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30253 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30255 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30256 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30257 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30259 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30260 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30261 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30262 verified as a sender.
30264 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30265 (eg. is generated from the received message)
30266 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30268 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30274 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30275 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30276 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30277 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30278 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30279 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30280 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30281 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30282 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30283 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30285 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30286 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30288 the following records are looked up:
30290 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30291 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30293 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30294 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30295 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30296 use two separate conditions:
30298 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30299 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30301 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30302 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30303 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30306 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30307 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30308 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30309 following special items in the list:
30311 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30312 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30313 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30315 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30316 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30317 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30318 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30320 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30322 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30323 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30325 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30326 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30327 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30329 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30331 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30332 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30333 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30334 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30335 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30336 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30340 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30341 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30342 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30343 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30344 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30346 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30348 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30349 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30350 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30351 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
30356 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
30357 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
30358 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
30359 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
30360 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
30361 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
30362 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
30364 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
30365 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30367 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
30368 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
30369 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
30370 up by this example is
30372 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
30374 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
30375 addresses. For example:
30377 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30378 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30380 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
30381 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
30386 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
30387 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
30388 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
30389 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
30390 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
30391 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
30392 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
30393 either to double the separators like this:
30395 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
30397 or to change the separator character, like this:
30399 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
30401 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
30402 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
30403 occurs. Consider this condition:
30405 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
30407 The DNS lookups that occur are:
30409 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30410 a.domain.black.list.tld
30412 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30413 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30414 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30415 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30416 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30417 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30418 error for a previous item.
30420 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30421 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30423 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30424 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30426 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30427 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30429 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30430 $sender_address_domain \
30431 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30433 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30434 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30435 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30437 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30438 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30439 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30440 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30442 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30444 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30445 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30447 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30448 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30453 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30454 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30455 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30456 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30457 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30458 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30462 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30464 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30465 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30466 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30468 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30469 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30470 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30473 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30474 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30475 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30476 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30477 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30478 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30479 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30480 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30481 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30482 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30483 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30484 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30485 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30486 cases, for example:
30488 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30490 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30491 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30492 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30493 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30495 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30497 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30498 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30500 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30501 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30502 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30503 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30504 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30507 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30508 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30509 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30511 deny hosts = !+local_networks
30512 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30514 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30519 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30520 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30521 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30522 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30525 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30527 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30528 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30529 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30530 describes how multiple records are handled.
30532 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30533 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30534 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30536 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30538 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30539 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30540 first. For example:
30542 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30543 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30546 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30547 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30548 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30549 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30550 tested. For example:
30552 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30554 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30555 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30556 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30558 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30560 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30565 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30566 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30569 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30571 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30572 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30574 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30576 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30577 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30578 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30579 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30581 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30582 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30584 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30585 previous example is precisely equivalent to
30587 deny dnslists = a.b.c
30588 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30590 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30591 Consider this example:
30593 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30595 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30598 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30600 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30602 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30603 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30604 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30606 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30611 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30612 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30613 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30614 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30615 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30616 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30618 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30620 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30621 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30622 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30623 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30624 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30625 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30628 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30629 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30630 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30632 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30633 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30636 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30638 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30639 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30641 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30643 for the condition to be true.
30646 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30647 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30649 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30650 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30652 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30654 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30655 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30657 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30658 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30660 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30662 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30663 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30665 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30667 for the condition to be false.
30669 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30670 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30675 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30676 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30677 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30678 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30679 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30680 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
30681 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
30682 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
30683 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
30686 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30687 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30688 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30689 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30690 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30691 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30692 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30695 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30696 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30698 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30699 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30701 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30702 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30703 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30704 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30705 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30706 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30708 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30709 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30710 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30712 reject dnslists = \
30713 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30714 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30715 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30716 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30718 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30719 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30720 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30724 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30725 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30726 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30727 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30728 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
30729 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30731 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30732 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30734 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30735 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30736 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30738 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30740 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30741 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30743 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30744 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30746 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30747 dnslists = some.list.example
30750 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30751 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30752 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30754 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30757 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30758 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30759 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30760 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30761 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30762 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30763 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30764 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30765 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30766 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30768 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30770 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30771 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30773 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30774 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30775 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30778 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30779 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30780 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30781 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30782 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30783 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30784 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30785 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30786 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30788 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30789 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30790 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30791 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30793 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30794 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30795 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30796 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30797 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30798 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30799 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30800 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30801 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30802 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30804 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30805 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30806 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30809 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30810 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30811 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30812 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30813 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30814 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30816 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30817 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30818 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30819 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30820 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30821 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30822 the &%count=%& option.
30825 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30826 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30827 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30828 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30829 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30831 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30832 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30833 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30834 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30836 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30837 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30838 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30839 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30840 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30841 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30842 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30844 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30845 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30846 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30847 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30848 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30849 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30850 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30852 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30853 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30854 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30855 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30858 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30859 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30860 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30861 multiple different commands.
30863 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30864 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30865 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30866 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30867 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30869 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30872 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30873 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30874 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30875 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30876 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30878 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30879 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30881 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30882 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30883 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30884 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30888 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30889 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30890 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30893 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30894 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30895 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30898 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30899 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30900 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30901 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30902 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30903 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30906 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30907 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30908 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30909 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30910 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30913 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30914 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30915 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30916 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30917 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30918 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30921 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30922 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30923 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
30924 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
30925 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
30926 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
30927 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30928 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
30929 from getting any email through.
30931 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30932 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30933 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30934 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30935 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30936 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
30937 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
30938 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
30940 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
30944 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
30945 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
30946 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
30947 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
30948 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
30949 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
30950 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
30951 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
30952 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
30954 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
30955 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
30956 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
30957 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
30958 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
30959 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
30961 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
30962 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
30965 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
30966 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
30967 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
30968 required increases with larger limits.
30970 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
30971 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
30972 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
30973 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
30974 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
30975 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
30976 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
30977 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
30978 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
30982 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
30983 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
30984 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
30985 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
30986 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
30987 message. For example:
30989 # Log all senders' rates
30990 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
30991 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
30993 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
30994 # at the decimal point.
30995 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
30996 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
30997 $sender_rate_limit }s
30999 # Keep authenticated users under control
31000 deny authenticated = *
31001 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31003 # System-wide rate limit
31004 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31005 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31007 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31008 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31009 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31010 messages per $sender_rate_period
31011 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31012 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31013 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31015 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31016 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31017 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31018 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31019 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31020 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31021 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31025 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31026 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31027 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31028 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31029 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31030 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31031 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31032 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31033 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31035 verify = sender/callout
31036 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31038 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31039 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31040 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31041 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31042 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31043 The available options are as follows:
31046 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31047 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31048 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31050 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31051 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31052 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31053 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31055 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31056 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31058 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31059 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31060 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31061 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31064 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31065 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31066 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31067 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31068 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31069 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31072 warn !verify = sender
31073 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31075 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31076 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31077 verification failure.
31079 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31080 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31083 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31084 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31086 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31088 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31089 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31090 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31092 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31094 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31097 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31098 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31103 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31104 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31105 .cindex "callout" "verification"
31106 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31107 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31108 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31109 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31110 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31111 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31112 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31113 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31114 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31117 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31118 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31119 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31120 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31121 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31122 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31124 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31125 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31126 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31127 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31128 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31130 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31131 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31132 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31133 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31134 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31135 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31136 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31137 supplies a host list.
31138 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31140 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31141 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31142 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31143 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31144 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31145 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31146 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31148 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31149 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31150 following SMTP commands are sent:
31152 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31154 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31157 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31160 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31163 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31164 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31165 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31166 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31167 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31168 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31170 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31171 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31172 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31173 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31174 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31176 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31177 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31178 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31179 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31180 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31185 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31186 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31187 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31188 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31190 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31192 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31193 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31194 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31198 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31199 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31200 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31203 verify = sender/callout=5s
31205 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31206 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31207 the &%connect%& parameter.
31210 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31211 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31212 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31213 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31215 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31217 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31219 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
31220 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31221 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31222 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31223 updated in this circumstance.
31225 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31226 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31227 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31228 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31229 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31230 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31233 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31234 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31235 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31236 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31237 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31238 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31239 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31240 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31241 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31242 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31244 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31246 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31249 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31250 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31251 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31254 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31256 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31257 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31258 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31259 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31260 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
31263 .vitem &*no_cache*&
31264 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31265 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31266 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31268 .vitem &*postmaster*&
31269 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31270 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31271 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31272 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31273 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31274 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31275 made, until the cache record expires.
31277 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31278 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31279 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31282 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31284 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31285 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31287 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31289 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31290 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31291 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31292 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31296 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31297 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31298 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31299 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31300 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31302 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31304 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31305 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31306 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31307 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31308 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31310 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31311 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31312 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31314 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31316 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31317 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31318 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31319 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31320 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31322 .vitem &*use_sender*&
31323 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31325 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31327 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31328 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31329 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31330 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31331 usefulness of callout caching.
31334 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31336 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31338 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
31339 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31340 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31341 when that is used for the connections.
31342 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31343 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31344 if the use_sender option is used,
31345 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
31346 and if no other callouts intervene.
31349 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
31350 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
31351 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
31352 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
31353 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
31354 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
31355 these circumstances.
31357 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
31358 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
31359 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
31360 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
31361 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
31362 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
31363 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
31365 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
31366 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
31367 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
31368 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
31373 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
31374 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
31375 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
31376 .cindex "caching" "callout"
31377 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
31378 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
31379 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
31380 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
31381 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
31382 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
31384 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
31385 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
31388 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
31389 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
31390 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
31392 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
31393 commands up to and including
31397 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
31398 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
31399 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
31400 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
31401 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
31402 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
31403 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
31405 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
31406 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
31407 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31408 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31409 will eventually be noticed.
31411 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31412 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31413 behaviour will be the same.
31417 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31418 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31419 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31420 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31421 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31422 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31425 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31427 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31428 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31429 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31430 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31431 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31432 550 Sender verification failed
31434 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31435 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31436 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31437 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31440 verify = sender/no_details
31443 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31444 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31445 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31446 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31447 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31448 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31449 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31452 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31453 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31454 verification also fails.
31456 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31457 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31460 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31461 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31462 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31465 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31467 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31468 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31469 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31470 verification to succeed.
31472 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31473 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31474 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31475 option. For example:
31477 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31479 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31480 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31482 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31483 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31484 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31485 address and a report is output for each of them.
31489 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31490 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31491 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31492 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31493 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31494 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31495 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31499 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31500 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31501 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31502 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31503 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31504 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31506 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31507 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31508 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31509 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31512 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31514 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31516 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31517 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31519 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31520 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31523 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31524 use for the DNS query. The default is:
31526 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31528 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31529 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31530 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31531 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31534 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31536 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31537 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31538 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31540 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31541 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31542 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31543 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31544 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31545 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31546 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31547 of legitimate HELO domains.
31549 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31550 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31551 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31552 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31555 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31557 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31558 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31559 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31564 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31565 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
31566 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31567 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31568 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31569 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31570 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31571 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31573 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31574 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31575 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31576 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31577 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31578 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31579 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31580 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
31582 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31583 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31586 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31587 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31590 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31591 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31594 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31595 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31597 recipients = +batv_senders
31599 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31600 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31602 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31603 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31604 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31606 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31607 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31608 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31609 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31610 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31612 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31613 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31614 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31615 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31616 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31617 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31618 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31620 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31621 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31622 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31623 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31627 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31629 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31630 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31631 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31634 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31637 external_smtp_batv:
31639 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31640 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31641 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31642 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31645 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31649 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31650 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31651 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31652 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31653 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31654 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31655 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31656 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31657 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31658 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31660 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31661 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31662 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31663 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31664 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31665 same host is fulfilling both functions,
31667 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
31669 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
31670 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
31671 system to arbitrary domains.
31674 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
31675 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
31676 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
31677 example, suppose you want to do the following:
31680 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
31681 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
31682 &'my.dom2.example'&.
31684 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
31685 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
31687 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
31688 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
31692 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
31694 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
31695 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
31696 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
31698 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
31702 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31703 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31705 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31706 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31707 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31708 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31709 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31710 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31711 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31715 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31716 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31717 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31718 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31719 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31724 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31725 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31727 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31728 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31729 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31730 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31731 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31732 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31735 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31736 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31737 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31738 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31739 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31741 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31742 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31743 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31746 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31747 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31749 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31750 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31751 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31753 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31754 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31756 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31759 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31762 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31763 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31764 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31765 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31766 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31767 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31769 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31770 temporarily created in a file called:
31772 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31774 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31775 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31776 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31777 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31778 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31780 control = no_mbox_unspool
31782 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31783 same directory by default.
31787 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31788 .cindex "virus scanning"
31789 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31790 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31791 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31792 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31793 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31794 in memory and thus are much faster.
31796 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31797 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31799 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31800 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31801 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31802 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31804 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31806 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31808 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31810 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31812 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31813 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
31815 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
31820 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31821 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31822 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
31823 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31824 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31825 This scanner type takes one option,
31826 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31827 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31828 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31829 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31830 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
31831 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31834 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31835 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31837 If you omit the argument, the default path
31838 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31840 If you use a remote host,
31841 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31842 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31843 For information about available commands and their options you may use
31845 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31851 Only the first virus detected will be reported.
31854 .vitem &%aveserver%&
31855 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31856 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31857 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31858 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31861 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31866 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31867 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31868 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31869 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31870 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31872 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31873 a UNIX socket specification,
31874 a TCP socket specification,
31875 or a (global) option.
31877 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31878 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31879 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31880 and the second a port number,
31881 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31882 These per-server options are supported:
31884 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31887 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31888 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31890 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31894 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31895 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31896 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31897 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31898 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31900 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31902 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31903 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31904 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31905 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31907 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31908 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31909 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31910 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31911 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31912 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31913 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31914 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31915 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31917 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31918 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31919 (Connection refused)
31922 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31923 contributing the code for this scanner.
31926 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31927 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31928 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
31929 type takes 3 mandatory options:
31932 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
31933 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
31936 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
31937 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
31938 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
31939 the &"trigger"& expression.
31942 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
31943 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
31944 &"name"& expression.
31947 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
31949 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
31951 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
31952 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
31953 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
31954 configuration setting:
31956 av_scanner = cmdline:\
31957 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
31958 found in file:'(.+)'
31961 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
31962 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
31964 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31965 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31966 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31967 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31970 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
31971 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
31973 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
31974 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
31977 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
31978 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
31979 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
31983 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
31985 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31987 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
31988 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
31989 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
31990 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
31993 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
31995 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31998 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
31999 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
32000 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32002 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32004 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32005 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32007 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32008 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32009 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32010 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32011 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32014 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32016 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32019 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32020 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
32021 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
32022 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
32023 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32024 provided that mksd has
32025 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32027 av_scanner = mksd:2
32029 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32032 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32033 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32034 running on the local machine.
32035 There are four options:
32036 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32037 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32038 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32039 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32040 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32043 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32045 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32046 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32047 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32048 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32049 specify an empty element to get this.
32052 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32053 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32054 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
32055 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32056 client communication. For example:
32058 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32060 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32064 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32065 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32068 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32069 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32070 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32071 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32072 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32073 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32076 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32077 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32078 The first element can then be one of
32081 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32082 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32085 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32086 the condition fails immediately.
32088 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32089 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32090 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32091 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32092 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
32095 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32096 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32097 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32099 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32100 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32103 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32105 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32107 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32108 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32109 is set to record the actual address used.
32111 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32112 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32113 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32114 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32117 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32118 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32120 Here is a very simple scanning example:
32122 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32125 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32127 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32128 malware = */defer_ok
32130 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32131 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32133 av_scanner = $acl_m0
32135 in the main Exim configuration.
32137 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32138 set acl_m0 = sophie
32141 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32142 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32147 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32148 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32149 .cindex "spam scanning"
32150 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
32152 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32153 score and a report for the message.
32154 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32156 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32157 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32158 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
32160 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32162 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32164 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32165 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32168 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32169 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32170 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32171 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32172 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32173 configuration as follows (example):
32175 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
32177 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32178 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32179 iptables firewall, consider setting
32180 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32181 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32182 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32183 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32187 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
32189 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
32191 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
32194 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
32195 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
32196 file name instead of an address/port pair:
32198 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
32200 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
32201 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
32202 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32203 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
32205 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32206 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32209 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32210 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32211 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32214 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32215 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32216 and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
32218 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32219 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32220 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32221 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32223 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32225 The supported options are:
32227 pri=<priority> Selection priority
32228 weight=<value> Selection bias
32229 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32230 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32231 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32232 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32235 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32236 higher values being tried first.
32237 The default priority is 1.
32239 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32240 Within a priority set
32241 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32242 The default value for selection bias is 1.
32244 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32245 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32246 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32247 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32249 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32250 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32252 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32253 The default value is two minutes.
32255 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32256 a failed connect is made.
32257 The default is to not retry.
32259 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32260 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32261 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32264 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32265 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32266 is set to record the actual address used.
32268 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32269 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32271 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32274 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32275 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32276 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32277 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32278 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
32281 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32282 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32283 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32284 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32285 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32287 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32288 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32290 or the use of PRDR,
32291 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32292 are needed to use this feature.
32294 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32295 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32296 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32299 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32300 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32301 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32304 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32305 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32309 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32310 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32311 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32312 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32314 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32315 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32317 Except for &$spam_report$&,
32318 these variables are saved with the received message so are
32319 available for use at delivery time.
32322 .vitem &$spam_score$&
32323 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
32324 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
32326 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
32327 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
32328 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
32329 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
32330 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
32332 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
32333 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
32334 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
32335 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
32336 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
32337 spam bar is 50 characters.
32339 .vitem &$spam_report$&
32340 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
32341 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
32342 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
32343 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
32344 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
32345 unencoded in headers.
32347 .vitem &$spam_action$&
32348 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
32349 spam score versus threshold.
32350 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
32354 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
32355 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
32356 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
32358 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
32359 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
32360 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
32361 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
32362 spam condition, like this:
32364 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32365 spam = joe/defer_ok
32367 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
32369 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
32372 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
32373 warn spam = nobody:true
32374 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
32375 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
32377 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
32378 # is over threshold
32380 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
32382 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
32383 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
32385 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
32390 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
32391 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
32392 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
32393 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
32394 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
32395 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
32396 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
32397 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
32398 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
32399 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
32402 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
32403 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
32404 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
32405 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
32406 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
32407 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
32408 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
32410 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
32411 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32412 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32413 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32414 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32416 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32417 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32418 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32419 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32420 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32423 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32425 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32429 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32431 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32432 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32433 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32434 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32436 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32437 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32438 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32439 the full path and file name.
32441 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32442 filename, and the default path is then used.
32444 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32445 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32446 a file with its original, proposed filename using
32448 decode = $mime_filename
32450 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32451 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32452 automatically unlinked.
32454 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32455 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32456 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32457 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32458 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32460 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32461 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32462 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32464 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32465 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32466 available in the MIME ACL:
32469 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32470 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32471 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32472 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32473 contains the empty string.
32475 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
32476 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32477 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32483 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32484 case-insensitively.
32486 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32487 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32488 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32489 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32490 only used for display purposes.
32492 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32493 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32494 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32496 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32497 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32498 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32500 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32501 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32502 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32503 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32504 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32506 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32507 This variable contains the normalized content of the
32508 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32509 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32511 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32512 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32513 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32514 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32518 application/octet-stream
32522 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32525 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32526 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32527 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32528 containing the decoded data.
32533 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
32534 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32535 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32536 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32539 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32541 found, this variable contains the empty string.
32543 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32544 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32545 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32546 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32548 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32549 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32553 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32556 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32557 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32560 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32561 and the rest are attachments.
32564 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32567 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32568 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32569 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32571 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32572 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32573 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32574 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32576 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32577 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32578 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32579 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32580 want to carry out specific actions on them.
32582 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32583 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32584 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32585 decoding is fully recursive.
32587 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32588 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32589 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32590 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32591 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32592 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32593 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32598 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32599 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32600 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32601 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32602 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32604 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32605 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32606 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32607 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32608 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32610 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32611 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32612 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32613 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32614 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
32615 32K characters are checked.
32617 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32618 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32619 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32620 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32621 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32623 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32624 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32626 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32627 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32628 matching regular expression.
32629 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32630 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32632 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32640 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32641 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32643 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32644 "Local scan function"
32645 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32646 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32647 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32648 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32649 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32651 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32652 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32653 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32654 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32655 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32657 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32658 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32659 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32660 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32662 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32663 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32664 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32665 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32667 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32668 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32669 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32670 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32671 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32672 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32673 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32674 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32675 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32679 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32680 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32681 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32682 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32683 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32684 directory, so you might set
32686 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32688 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32689 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32690 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32691 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32692 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32693 _src/local_scan.c_.
32695 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32696 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32698 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32700 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32705 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32706 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32707 You must include this line near the start of your code:
32709 #include "local_scan.h"
32711 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32712 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32713 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32714 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32715 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32716 strings and pointers to character strings:
32718 #define CS (char *)
32719 #define CCS (const char *)
32720 #define CSS (char **)
32721 #define US (unsigned char *)
32722 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32723 #define USS (unsigned char **)
32725 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32727 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32729 The arguments are as follows:
32732 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32733 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32734 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32736 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32737 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32738 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32739 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32740 case this changes in some future version.
32742 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32743 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32746 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32749 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32750 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32751 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32752 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32753 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32754 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32756 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32757 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32758 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32760 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32761 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32762 queued without immediate delivery.
32764 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32765 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32766 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32767 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32768 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32771 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32772 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32773 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32776 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32777 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32778 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32779 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32780 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32781 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32782 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32784 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32785 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32786 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32789 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32790 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32791 &%-oe%& command line options.
32795 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32796 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32797 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32798 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32799 want to do this, you must have the line
32801 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32803 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32804 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32805 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32808 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32809 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32810 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32811 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32812 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32813 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32815 static int my_integer_option = 42;
32816 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32818 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32819 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32820 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32823 int local_scan_options_count =
32824 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32826 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32827 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32831 my_string = some string of text...
32833 The available types of option data are as follows:
32836 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
32837 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32838 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32839 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32840 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32841 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32844 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32845 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32846 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32847 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32850 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32851 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32854 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32855 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32856 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32857 printed with the suffix K or M.
32859 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
32860 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32861 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32862 always output in octal.
32864 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32865 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32866 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32868 .vitem &*opt_time*&
32869 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32870 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32873 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32874 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32878 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32879 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32880 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32881 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32882 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32883 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32884 C variables are as follows:
32887 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32888 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32889 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32891 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32892 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32893 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32895 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32896 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32897 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32898 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32901 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32902 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32903 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32906 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32907 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32911 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32912 selected, you should use code like this:
32914 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32915 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32917 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32918 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32919 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32921 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32922 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
32925 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32926 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32928 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32929 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32931 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32932 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32933 &%-bh%& command line option.
32935 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32936 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32937 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32939 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32940 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32941 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32942 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
32944 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
32945 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
32946 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
32948 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
32949 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32951 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32952 The number of accepted recipients.
32954 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32955 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32956 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32957 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32958 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32959 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32960 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32961 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32962 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32963 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32964 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32965 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32967 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32968 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32970 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32971 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32972 locally-submitted messages.
32974 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32975 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32976 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32978 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32979 The name of the sending host, if known.
32981 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32982 The port on the sending host.
32984 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32985 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32987 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32988 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32990 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32991 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32992 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32996 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32997 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32998 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32999 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33004 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33005 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33007 .vitem &*int&~type*&
33008 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33009 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33010 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33011 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33012 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33013 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33015 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33016 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33019 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33020 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33021 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33026 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33027 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33030 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33031 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33033 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33034 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33035 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33036 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33038 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33039 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33040 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33041 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33042 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33043 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33044 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33045 is NULL for all recipients.
33050 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33051 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33052 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33053 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33057 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33058 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33060 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33061 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33062 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33063 for the process in &%newumask%&.
33065 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33066 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33067 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33068 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33069 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33071 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33073 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33074 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33075 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33076 return value is as follows:
33081 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33087 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33093 The process timed out.
33097 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33100 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33101 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33102 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33103 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33104 forks a subprocess that is running
33106 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33108 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33109 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33110 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33111 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33113 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33114 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33115 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33116 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33119 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33120 *sender_authentication)*&
33121 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33124 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33126 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33129 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33130 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33131 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33132 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33133 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33135 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33136 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33139 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33140 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33141 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33142 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33143 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33144 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33145 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33146 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33148 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33149 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33150 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33151 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33152 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33153 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33155 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33156 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33157 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33158 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33160 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33161 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33162 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33163 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33164 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33165 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33166 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33167 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33168 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33169 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33171 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33172 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33174 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33175 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33178 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33179 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33180 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33181 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33182 match the specification, the function does nothing.
33185 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33186 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
33187 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
33188 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
33189 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
33190 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
33192 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
33194 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
33195 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
33196 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
33197 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
33198 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
33201 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
33202 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33203 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33204 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33205 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33206 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33207 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33208 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33210 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33211 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33212 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33214 &`OK `& match succeeded
33215 &`FAIL `& match failed
33216 &`DEFER `& match deferred
33218 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33219 inability to contact a database.
33221 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33223 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33224 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33225 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33227 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33229 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33230 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33231 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33233 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33235 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33238 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33240 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33241 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33242 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33243 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33244 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33245 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33248 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33250 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33251 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33252 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33253 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33254 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33255 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33258 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33259 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33260 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33261 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33263 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33264 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33265 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33266 value afterwards. For example:
33268 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33269 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33270 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33273 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33274 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33275 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33276 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33283 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33284 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33285 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33286 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33287 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33288 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33289 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33290 binary string is returned with an error message.
33292 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33293 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33294 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33296 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33297 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33298 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33299 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33300 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33302 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33303 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33304 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33306 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33307 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33308 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33309 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33313 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33314 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33317 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33318 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
33319 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
33320 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
33321 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
33322 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
33323 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
33324 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
33327 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
33328 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
33330 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
33331 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
33332 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
33333 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
33334 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
33335 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
33336 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
33338 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
33339 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
33341 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
33342 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
33343 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
33344 multiple output lines.
33346 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
33347 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
33348 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
33349 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
33350 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
33351 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
33352 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
33355 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
33356 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
33357 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
33358 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33360 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
33361 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
33362 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33364 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
33367 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
33370 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
33371 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
33372 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
33373 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
33374 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
33375 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
33381 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
33382 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
33383 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
33384 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
33385 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
33386 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
33387 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
33390 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
33391 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
33392 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
33393 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
33395 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
33396 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
33398 store_pool = POOL_PERM
33400 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
33401 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
33402 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
33403 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
33405 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
33406 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
33407 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
33408 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
33415 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33416 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33418 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33419 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33420 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33421 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33422 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33423 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33424 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33425 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33427 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33428 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33429 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33430 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33431 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33433 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33434 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33435 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33436 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33437 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33438 prevent it happening on retries.
33440 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33441 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33442 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33443 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33444 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33445 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33446 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33447 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33450 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33451 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33452 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33453 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33454 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33455 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33456 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33458 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33459 system_filter_user = exim
33461 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33462 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33463 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33464 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33465 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33466 by the &%reply%& command.
33469 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33470 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33471 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33472 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33474 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33475 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33479 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33480 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33481 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33482 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33483 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33484 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33487 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33488 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33489 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33490 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33491 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33492 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33493 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33495 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33496 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33497 succeed, it will not be tried again.
33498 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33499 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33501 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33502 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33503 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33504 to which users' filter files can refer.
33508 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33509 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
33510 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33511 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33512 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33516 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33517 .cindex "freezing messages"
33518 .cindex "message" "freezing"
33519 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
33520 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33521 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33522 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33523 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33524 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33525 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33526 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33527 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33529 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33531 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33533 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33534 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33535 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33536 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33537 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33540 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33541 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33542 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33543 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33545 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33546 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33547 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33548 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33549 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33550 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33551 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33552 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33553 message. For example:
33555 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33556 because it contains attachments that we are \
33557 not prepared to receive."
33560 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33561 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33562 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33563 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33564 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33565 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33568 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33569 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33571 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33572 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33573 generated by the filter.
33575 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33577 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33578 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33584 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33585 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33590 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33591 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33592 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33593 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33594 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33596 headers add <string>
33597 headers remove <string>
33599 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33600 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33601 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33602 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33603 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33605 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33606 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33607 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33610 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33611 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33614 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33615 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33616 space after input continuations is ignored.
33618 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33619 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33620 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33621 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33622 header with the same name, they are all removed.
33624 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33625 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33626 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33627 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33628 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33629 used for all recipients of the message.
33631 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33632 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33633 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33634 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33635 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33636 until the message is actually being written (see section
33637 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33639 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33640 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33641 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33642 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33643 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33644 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33645 modified more than once.
33647 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33648 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33651 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33652 headers remove "Subject"
33653 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33654 headers remove "Old-Subject"
33659 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33660 .cindex "envelope sender"
33661 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33663 errors_to <some address>
33665 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33666 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33667 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33670 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33672 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33673 address if its delivery failed.
33677 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33678 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33679 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33680 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33681 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33682 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33683 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33684 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33685 which implements such a filter:
33690 domains = +local_domains
33691 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33696 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33697 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33698 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33699 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33701 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33702 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33703 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33704 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33706 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
33707 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
33708 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
33715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33716 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33718 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33719 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33720 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33721 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33722 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33723 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33724 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33725 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33727 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33728 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33729 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33730 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33731 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33733 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33734 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33735 loopback interface specially in any way.
33737 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33738 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33743 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33744 .cindex "message" "submission"
33745 .cindex "submission mode"
33746 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33747 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33748 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33749 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33751 control = submission
33753 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33754 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33755 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33756 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33757 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33758 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33760 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33761 control = submission
33763 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33764 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33765 is used to separate options. For example:
33767 control = submission/sender_retain
33769 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33770 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33771 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33772 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33773 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33774 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33775 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33777 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33778 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33781 control = submission/domain=some.domain
33783 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33784 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33785 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33786 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33788 accept authenticated = *
33789 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33790 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33791 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33793 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33794 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33795 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33797 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33799 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33802 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33804 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33805 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33806 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33807 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33809 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33810 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33811 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33812 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33813 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33814 spoof another's address.
33816 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33817 .cindex "line endings"
33818 .cindex "carriage return"
33820 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33821 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33822 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33823 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33824 use CRLF or just CR.
33826 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33827 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33828 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33829 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33830 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33831 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33832 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33833 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33837 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33839 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33842 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33843 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33846 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33847 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33848 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33849 people trying to play silly games.
33851 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33852 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33860 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33861 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
33862 .cindex "address" "qualification"
33863 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33864 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33865 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33866 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33867 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33869 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33870 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33871 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33872 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33873 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33875 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33876 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33877 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33878 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33879 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33880 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33881 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33882 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33887 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33888 .cindex "&""From""& line"
33889 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33890 .cindex "sender" "address"
33891 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33892 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33893 .cindex "envelope sender"
33894 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33895 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33896 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33897 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33899 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33900 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33902 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33903 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33904 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33905 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33906 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33907 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33908 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33909 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33910 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33912 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33913 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33914 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33915 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33916 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33917 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33918 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33920 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33921 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33922 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
33924 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
33925 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33926 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33927 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33931 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33932 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33933 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
33934 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33935 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33936 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33937 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33938 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33941 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33942 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
33945 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
33946 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
33950 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33951 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33953 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33954 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33955 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33957 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33960 For a locally-submitted message,
33961 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33962 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33963 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33964 included in log lines in this case.
33966 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33967 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33973 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33974 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33975 includes the header line:
33977 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33980 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33981 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33982 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33983 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33984 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33985 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33988 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33989 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33990 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
33991 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33992 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33993 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33995 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33996 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33997 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33998 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33999 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34000 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34001 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34002 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34006 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34007 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34008 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34009 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34010 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34011 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34012 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34013 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34014 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34018 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34019 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34020 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34021 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34022 .cindex "message" "submission"
34023 .cindex "submission mode"
34024 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34025 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34028 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34029 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34031 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34032 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34034 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34035 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34036 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34038 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34039 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34041 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34042 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34046 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34048 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34049 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34050 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34051 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34052 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34053 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34054 &%qualify_domain%&.
34056 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34057 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34058 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34059 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34062 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34063 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34064 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34065 .cindex "message" "submission"
34066 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34067 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34068 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34069 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34070 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34071 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34072 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34073 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34074 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34075 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34078 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34079 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34080 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34081 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34082 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34083 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34085 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34086 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34087 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34088 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34090 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34091 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34092 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34095 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34096 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34097 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
34098 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34099 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34100 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34101 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34102 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34103 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34104 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34105 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
34106 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34110 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34111 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34112 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34113 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34114 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34115 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34116 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34117 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34118 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34122 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34123 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34124 .cindex "message" "submission"
34125 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34126 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34127 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34128 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34129 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34132 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34133 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34134 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34135 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34136 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34137 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34138 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34139 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34140 line is added to the message.
34142 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34143 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34144 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34145 options true at the same time.
34147 .cindex "submission mode"
34148 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34149 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34150 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34151 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34153 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34154 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34155 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34156 created as follows:
34159 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34160 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34161 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34163 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34164 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34166 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34167 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34170 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34171 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34172 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34173 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34175 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34176 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34177 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34178 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34182 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
34183 "SECTheadersaddrem"
34184 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
34185 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
34186 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
34187 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
34188 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
34189 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
34190 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
34192 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
34193 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
34194 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
34195 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
34196 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
34197 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
34199 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
34200 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
34201 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
34203 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34204 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34205 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34207 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34208 X-added-second: another added header line
34210 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34212 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34213 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34214 Each header-line is separately expanded.
34216 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34217 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34218 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34219 not part of the names. For example:
34221 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34224 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34225 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34226 Each item is separately expanded.
34227 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34228 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34229 will act as list separators.
34231 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34232 items are expanded at routing time,
34233 and then associated with all addresses that are
34234 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34235 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34236 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34238 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
34239 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34240 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34241 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34243 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34244 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34245 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34248 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34249 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34250 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34251 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34252 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34253 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34254 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34256 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34257 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34258 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34259 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34261 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34262 the following consequences:
34265 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34266 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34267 to it, at all times.
34269 Header lines that are added by a router's
34270 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34271 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34273 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34274 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34276 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34277 a later router or by a transport.
34279 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34280 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34282 headers_remove = subject
34283 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34287 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34288 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34294 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34295 .cindex "address" "constructed"
34296 .cindex "constructed address"
34297 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34300 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34304 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34306 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34307 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34308 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34309 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34310 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34311 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34312 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34313 there is no password file entry.
34316 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34317 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34318 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
34319 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
34320 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
34321 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
34322 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
34323 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
34327 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
34328 .cindex "case of local parts"
34329 .cindex "local part" "case of"
34330 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
34331 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
34332 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
34333 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
34334 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
34335 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
34338 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
34339 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
34340 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
34341 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
34342 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
34346 domains = +local_domains
34347 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
34348 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
34351 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
34352 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
34353 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
34354 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
34355 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
34359 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
34360 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
34361 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
34362 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
34363 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
34364 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
34365 empty components for compatibility.
34369 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
34370 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
34371 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
34372 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
34373 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
34374 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
34376 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
34377 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
34378 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
34379 example, a header such as
34383 might get rewritten as
34385 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
34387 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
34388 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
34391 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
34392 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
34393 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
34394 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
34395 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
34396 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
34397 .ecindex IIDmesproc
34401 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34402 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34404 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
34405 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
34406 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
34407 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
34408 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
34409 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
34410 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
34413 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34415 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34417 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34420 For mail delivery, the following are available:
34423 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34425 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34428 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34431 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34432 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34435 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34436 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34437 used to contain the envelope information.
34441 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34442 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34443 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34444 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34445 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34448 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34449 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34450 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34451 processing is the same in both cases.
34453 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34454 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34455 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34456 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34457 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34458 .cindex "transport" "filter"
34459 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34460 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34463 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34464 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34465 required for the transaction.
34467 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34468 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34469 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34470 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34471 is called for verification.
34473 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34474 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34475 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34477 .cindex "carriage return"
34479 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34480 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34481 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34484 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34485 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34486 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34487 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34488 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34489 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34490 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34491 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34492 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34494 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34495 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34496 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34497 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34499 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34500 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34501 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34502 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34504 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34505 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34506 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34507 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34508 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34509 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34510 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34511 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34512 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34513 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34515 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34516 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34518 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34519 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34520 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34521 square bracket of the IP address.
34526 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34527 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34528 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34529 .cindex "host" "error"
34530 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34531 message errors, and recipient errors.
34534 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34535 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34536 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34539 Connection refused or timed out,
34541 Any error response code on connection,
34543 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34545 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34547 I/O errors at any time,
34549 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34550 the &"."& at the end of the data.
34553 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34554 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34555 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34556 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34557 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34558 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34559 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34560 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34562 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34563 .cindex "message" "error"
34564 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34565 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34566 message errors are:
34569 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34572 Timeout after MAIL,
34574 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34575 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34576 connection at any other time.
34579 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34580 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34581 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34582 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34583 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34584 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34585 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34586 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34587 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34588 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34590 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34591 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34592 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34595 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34596 .cindex "recipient" "error"
34597 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34598 recipient errors are:
34601 Any error response to RCPT,
34603 Timeout after RCPT.
34606 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34607 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34608 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34609 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34610 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34611 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34612 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34613 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34614 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34615 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34616 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34617 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34618 the retry clock is reset.
34620 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34621 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34622 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34623 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34624 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34625 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34626 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34627 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34628 recipient's retry time.
34631 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34632 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34633 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34634 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34635 until the next delivery attempt.
34637 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34638 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34639 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34640 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34641 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34644 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34645 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34646 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34647 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34648 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34649 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34650 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34652 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34653 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34654 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34655 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34656 then to be treated as a host error.
34658 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34659 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34660 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34661 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34662 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34667 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34668 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34669 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34672 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34673 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34674 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34676 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34678 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34679 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34680 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34681 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34682 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34683 stream and exits with an error code.
34685 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34686 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34687 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34688 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34690 .cindex "carriage return"
34692 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34693 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34694 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34696 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34697 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34698 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34700 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34701 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34702 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34703 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34704 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34705 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34706 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34707 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34709 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34710 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34711 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34712 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34713 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34714 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34715 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34716 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34717 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34719 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34720 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34721 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34723 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34724 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34725 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34726 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34727 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34729 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34730 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34731 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34732 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34733 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34734 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34735 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34737 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34738 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34739 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34740 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34741 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34743 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34744 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34745 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34746 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34747 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34748 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34749 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34750 a delivery process.
34752 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34753 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34754 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34755 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34756 however, available with &'inetd'&.
34758 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34759 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34760 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34761 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34763 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34764 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34765 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34769 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34770 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34771 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34772 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34773 the error response to the last command. The default value for
34774 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34775 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34776 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34779 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34780 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34781 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34782 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34783 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34784 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34785 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34786 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34787 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34788 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34789 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34793 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34794 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34795 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34796 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34797 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34798 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34799 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34800 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34802 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34803 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34804 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34805 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34806 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34809 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34810 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34811 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34813 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34814 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34815 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34816 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34817 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34822 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34823 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34824 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34825 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34827 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34828 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34829 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34830 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
34831 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34832 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34833 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34834 SMTP response codes.
34836 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34837 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34838 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34839 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34840 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34841 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34842 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34843 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34848 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34849 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34850 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34851 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34852 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34853 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34854 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34856 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34857 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34858 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34859 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34860 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34861 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34862 argument. For example,
34870 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34871 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34872 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34873 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34874 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34876 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34877 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34878 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34879 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34880 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34881 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34882 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34883 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34885 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34886 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34887 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34888 whatever the form of its argument. For
34891 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34892 $sender_host_address
34894 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34895 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34896 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34897 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34898 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34899 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34900 for it to change them before running the command.
34904 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34905 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34906 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34907 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34908 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34909 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34910 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34911 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34912 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34913 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34914 runs for RCPT commands:
34918 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34922 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34923 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
34924 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
34925 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
34926 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
34927 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
34928 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
34929 envelope along with the message.
34931 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
34932 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
34933 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
34934 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
34935 can be used to specify it.
34937 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
34938 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
34939 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34940 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34941 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
34944 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
34945 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
34946 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
34951 driver = manualroute
34952 transport = smtp_appendfile
34953 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
34957 driver = appendfile
34958 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
34963 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34964 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34965 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34969 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34970 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34971 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
34972 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34973 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34974 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34975 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34976 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34977 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34978 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34980 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34981 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34983 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34984 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34985 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34986 make some use of automatically, for example:
34988 554 Unexpected end of file
34989 Transaction started in line 10
34990 Error detected in line 14
34992 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34995 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34996 The error message was:
34998 501 '>' missing at end of address
35000 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35001 The error was detected in line 12.
35002 The SMTP command at fault was:
35004 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35006 1 previous message was successfully processed.
35007 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35009 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35010 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35012 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35013 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35017 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35018 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35020 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35021 "Customizing messages"
35022 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
35023 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35024 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35025 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35026 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35028 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35029 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35030 option. Exim also adds the line
35032 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35034 to all warning and bounce messages,
35037 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35038 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35039 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35040 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35041 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35042 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35043 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35045 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35046 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35047 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35048 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35049 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35052 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35053 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35054 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35055 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35056 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35057 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35058 option, rounded to a whole number.
35060 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35063 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35064 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35066 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35067 failing addresses with their error messages.
35069 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35070 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35072 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35073 The fields exist for back-compatibility
35076 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35077 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35078 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35080 Subject: Mail delivery failed
35081 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35082 {: returning message to sender}}
35084 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35086 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35087 {that you sent }{sent by
35091 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35092 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35094 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35096 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35099 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35101 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35104 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35105 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35106 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35107 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35108 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35112 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35113 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35115 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35116 the delayed addresses.
35118 The third item then ends the message.
35121 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35122 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35124 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35125 $warn_message_delay
35127 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35129 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35130 {that you sent }{sent by
35134 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35135 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
35137 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35138 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35139 The date of the message is: $h_date
35141 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35143 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35144 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35145 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35146 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35147 the message will be returned to you.
35149 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35150 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35151 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35152 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35153 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35154 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35155 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35156 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35162 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35165 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35166 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35167 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35171 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35172 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
35173 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35174 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35175 routing explicitly:
35177 send_to_smart_host:
35178 driver = manualroute
35179 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35180 transport = remote_smtp
35182 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
35183 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
35184 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
35185 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
35186 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
35191 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
35192 .cindex "mailing lists"
35193 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
35194 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
35195 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
35197 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
35198 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
35199 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
35200 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
35204 domains = lists.example
35205 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35208 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35211 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35212 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35213 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35214 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35216 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35217 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35220 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35221 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35222 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35223 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35224 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35226 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35227 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35228 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35229 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35230 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35231 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35232 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35233 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35234 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35238 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35239 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35240 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35241 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35242 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35243 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35244 addresses are not rigorously checked.
35246 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35247 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35248 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35249 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35250 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35254 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35255 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35256 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35257 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35258 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35259 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35260 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35261 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35262 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35263 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35265 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35266 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35267 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35268 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35269 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35270 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35271 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35272 pre-existing messages.
35274 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35275 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35276 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35277 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35278 one level of expansion anyway.
35282 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35283 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35284 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35285 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35286 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35287 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35289 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35290 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35294 domains = lists.example
35295 local_part_suffix = -request
35296 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35301 domains = lists.example
35302 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35303 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35304 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35307 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35312 domains = lists.example
35314 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35316 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35317 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35318 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
35321 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
35322 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
35323 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
35324 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
35325 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
35326 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
35327 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
35328 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
35329 &"unrouteable address"& error.
35331 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
35332 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
35333 the address, giving a suitable error message.
35338 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
35340 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
35341 .cindex "envelope sender"
35342 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
35343 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
35344 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
35345 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
35346 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
35347 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
35349 .oindex &%errors_to%&
35350 .oindex &%return_path%&
35351 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
35352 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
35353 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
35354 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
35355 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
35356 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
35357 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
35363 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35364 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35366 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
35367 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
35368 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
35369 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
35370 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
35371 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
35372 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
35375 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
35377 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35378 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
35379 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
35380 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
35381 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
35382 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
35384 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
35385 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
35386 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
35387 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
35391 domains = ! +local_domains
35393 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35394 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
35397 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
35398 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
35399 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
35400 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
35403 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
35404 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
35405 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
35406 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
35407 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
35411 domains = ! +local_domains
35412 transport = remote_smtp
35414 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35415 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35418 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35419 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35420 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35421 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35424 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35425 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35426 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35427 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35428 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35429 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35437 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35438 .cindex "virtual domains"
35439 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
35440 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35444 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35445 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35446 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35448 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35449 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35450 have login accounts on that host.
35453 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35454 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35455 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35456 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35457 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35458 to a router of this form:
35462 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35463 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35466 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35467 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35468 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35469 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35470 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35471 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35473 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35474 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35475 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35476 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35478 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35479 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35480 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35484 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35485 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35486 transport = my_mailboxes
35488 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35489 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35490 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35491 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35492 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35496 driver = appendfile
35497 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35500 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35501 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35503 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35504 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35505 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35506 information about the domains.
35510 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35511 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35512 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35513 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
35514 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
35515 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35516 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35517 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35518 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35519 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35520 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35521 example, consider this router:
35526 file = $home/.forward
35527 local_part_suffix = -*
35528 local_part_suffix_optional
35531 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35532 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35533 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35534 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35536 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35537 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35540 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35541 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35542 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35543 control over which suffixes are valid.
35545 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35546 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35552 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35553 local_part_suffix = -*
35554 local_part_suffix_optional
35557 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35558 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35559 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35560 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35561 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35565 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35566 .cindex "vacation processing"
35567 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35568 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35569 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35570 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35571 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35574 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35575 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35576 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35577 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35579 spqr, vacation-spqr
35582 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35583 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35584 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35585 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35586 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35590 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35591 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35595 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35596 .cindex "message" "copying every"
35597 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35598 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35599 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35600 each day's messages.
35602 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35603 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35604 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35605 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35609 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35610 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35611 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35612 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35613 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35614 permanently connected.
35616 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35617 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35618 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35621 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35622 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35623 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35624 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35625 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35626 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35627 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35628 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35630 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35631 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35632 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35633 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35634 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35635 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35638 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35639 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35640 intermittent host. For example:
35642 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35644 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35645 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35646 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35647 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35648 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35649 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35652 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35653 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35654 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35655 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35656 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35657 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35658 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35662 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35663 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35664 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35665 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35666 delivered immediately.
35668 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35669 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35670 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35671 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35672 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35673 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35674 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35675 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35676 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35677 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35678 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35679 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35680 single SMTP connection.
35684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35685 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35687 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35688 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35689 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
35690 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35691 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35692 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35693 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35694 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35695 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35696 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35699 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35700 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35701 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35702 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35703 email is not desirable.
35705 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35706 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35707 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35708 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35709 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35710 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35711 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35713 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35714 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35715 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35716 before sending a message to the smart host.
35718 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35719 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35720 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35722 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35723 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35724 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35725 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35726 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35727 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35728 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35730 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35734 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35735 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35737 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35738 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35739 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35740 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35741 successful, a zero return code is given.
35743 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35744 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35745 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35746 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35747 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35750 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35751 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35752 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35754 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35755 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35756 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35757 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35758 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35760 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35761 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35762 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35764 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35765 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35766 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35767 are ever generated.
35769 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35771 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35772 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35773 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35776 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35777 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35778 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35779 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35780 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35781 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35786 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35787 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35789 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35790 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35791 .cindex "log" "types of"
35792 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35797 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35798 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35799 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35800 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35801 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35802 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35803 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35804 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35806 .cindex "reject log"
35807 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35808 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35809 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35810 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35811 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35812 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35813 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35814 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35815 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35818 .cindex "panic log"
35819 .cindex "system log"
35820 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35821 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35822 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35823 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35824 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35825 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35826 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35827 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35828 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35831 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35832 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35833 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35835 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35838 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35839 ways of changing this:
35842 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35847 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35849 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35852 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35856 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35857 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35858 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35859 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35860 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35861 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35866 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35867 .cindex "log" "destination"
35868 .cindex "log" "to file"
35869 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
35871 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35872 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35873 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35874 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35875 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35876 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35877 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35879 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35880 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35881 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35882 references to the host name:
35884 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35886 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35887 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35888 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35889 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35890 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35893 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35894 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35895 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35896 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35897 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35898 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35899 implying the use of a default path.
35901 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35902 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35903 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35904 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35905 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35906 equivalent to the setting:
35908 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35910 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35911 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35912 that is where the logs are written.
35914 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35915 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35917 Here are some examples of possible settings:
35919 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35920 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35921 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35922 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
35924 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
35929 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
35930 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35931 .cindex "cycling logs"
35932 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35933 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
35934 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
35935 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
35936 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
35937 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
35938 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
35940 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35941 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35942 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
35943 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
35944 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
35945 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
35946 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
35947 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
35948 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
35949 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
35950 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
35955 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
35956 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
35957 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
35958 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
35959 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
35960 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
35961 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35962 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35964 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35965 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35966 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35967 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35969 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35970 examples of names generated by the above examples:
35972 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35973 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35974 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35975 /var/log/exim/main.200212
35977 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35978 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35979 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35980 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35982 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35983 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35984 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35985 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35986 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35987 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35990 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35991 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35992 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35993 /var/log/exim/panic
35997 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35998 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35999 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36000 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36001 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36002 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36003 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36004 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36005 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36006 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36007 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36008 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36009 the time and host name to each line.
36010 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36013 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36015 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36017 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36020 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36021 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36022 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36023 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36025 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36026 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36027 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36028 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36029 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36030 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36031 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36032 RFC 3164, you should set
36034 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36036 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36037 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36039 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36040 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36041 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36042 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36043 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36044 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36045 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36046 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36047 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36049 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36050 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36051 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36052 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36055 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36058 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36059 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36060 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36061 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36063 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36064 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36065 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36066 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36067 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36068 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
36070 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36071 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
36072 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36075 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36077 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36078 without modification.
36080 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36081 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36082 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36087 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36088 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36089 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36090 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36091 timestamp. The flags are:
36093 &`<=`& message arrival
36094 &`(=`& message fakereject
36095 &`=>`& normal message delivery
36096 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
36097 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36098 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36099 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36100 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36104 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36105 .cindex "log" "reception line"
36106 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36107 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36108 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36110 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36111 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36112 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36114 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36115 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36116 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36120 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36124 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36125 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36126 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36127 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36128 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36129 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36130 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36131 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36132 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36133 name in parentheses.
36135 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36136 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36137 the log containing text like these examples:
36139 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36140 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36142 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36145 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36146 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36149 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
36150 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36151 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36152 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36153 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36154 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36155 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36156 suite that was used.
36158 .cindex log protocol
36159 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36160 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36161 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36162 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36163 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36164 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36165 authenticator name.
36167 .cindex "size" "of message"
36168 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36169 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36170 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36171 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36174 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36175 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36179 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36180 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
36181 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36182 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
36183 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
36184 to fit it on the page:
36186 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
36187 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
36188 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
36189 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
36190 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
36192 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
36193 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
36194 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
36195 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
36196 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
36198 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
36199 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
36200 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
36201 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
36203 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36204 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36206 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36208 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36209 parentheses afterwards.
36211 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36212 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36213 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36214 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36215 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36216 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36217 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36218 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36219 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36220 TLS cipher information is still available.
36222 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36223 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36224 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36225 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36226 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36228 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36229 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36231 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36232 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36235 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36236 .cindex "discarded messages"
36237 .cindex "message" "discarded"
36238 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36239 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36240 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36242 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36243 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36245 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36246 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36248 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36249 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36253 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36254 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36256 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36257 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36259 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36260 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36261 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36263 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36264 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36266 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36267 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36268 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36272 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36273 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36274 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36275 following form is logged:
36277 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36278 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36280 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36281 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36283 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36284 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36285 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36286 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36287 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36289 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36290 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36291 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36292 flagged with &`**`&.
36296 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36297 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36298 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36299 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36300 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36304 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
36307 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36309 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36310 at the end of its processing.
36315 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36316 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36317 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36318 the following table:
36320 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
36321 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
36322 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36323 &`CV `& certificate verification status
36324 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36325 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
36326 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
36327 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36328 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
36329 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
36330 &`H `& host name and IP address
36331 &`I `& local interface used
36332 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
36333 &`id `& message id for incoming message
36334 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
36335 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
36336 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
36337 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
36338 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
36339 &`Q `& alternate queue name
36340 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
36341 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
36342 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
36343 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
36344 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
36345 &`S `& size of message in bytes
36346 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
36347 &`ST `& shadow transport name
36348 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
36349 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
36350 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
36351 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
36352 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
36356 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
36357 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
36358 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
36361 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
36362 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
36363 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
36364 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
36365 during the first delivery attempt.
36367 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
36368 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
36369 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
36371 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
36372 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
36373 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
36374 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
36375 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
36378 .cindex "error" "ignored"
36379 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
36382 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
36383 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
36385 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
36386 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36388 A delivery set up by a router configured with
36389 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
36390 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
36394 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36398 .cindex DKIM "log line"
36399 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
36400 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
36408 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
36409 .cindex "log" "selectors"
36410 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
36411 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
36412 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
36415 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
36417 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
36418 selection marked by asterisks:
36420 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36421 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36422 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36423 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36424 &` arguments `& command line arguments
36425 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36426 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36427 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36428 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36429 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
36430 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
36431 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36432 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36433 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36434 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36435 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36436 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36437 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36438 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36439 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
36440 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36441 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36442 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36443 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36444 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36445 &` pid `& Exim process id
36446 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36447 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36448 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36449 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36450 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36451 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36452 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36453 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36454 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36455 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36456 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36457 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36458 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36459 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36460 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36461 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36462 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36463 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36464 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36465 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36466 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36467 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36468 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36470 &` all `& all of the above
36472 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36473 section &<<SECID99>>&
36475 More details on each of these items follows:
36479 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36480 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36481 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36482 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36483 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36484 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36486 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36487 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36488 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36489 this log selector is set.
36491 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
36492 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36493 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36494 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36495 such users cannot access the log).
36497 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
36498 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36499 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36500 parentheses between them.
36502 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36503 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36504 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36505 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36506 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36507 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36508 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36509 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36510 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36511 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36512 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36513 between the caller and Exim.
36515 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36516 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36517 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36519 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36520 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36521 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36522 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36523 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36524 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36526 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36527 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36528 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36529 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36530 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
36532 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36533 .cindex "size" "of message"
36534 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36535 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36538 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36539 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36540 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
36541 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
36543 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36544 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36545 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
36548 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36549 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36550 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
36551 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36552 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36555 .cindex dnssec logging
36556 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36557 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36558 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36559 It does not cover helo-name verification.
36560 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36562 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36563 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36564 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36565 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36566 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36567 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36569 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36570 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36571 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36572 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36573 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36575 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36576 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36577 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36578 client's ident port times out.
36580 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36581 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36582 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36583 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36584 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36585 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36586 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36587 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36588 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36589 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36590 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36592 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36593 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36594 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36595 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36596 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36597 on a proxied connection
36598 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36599 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36601 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36602 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
36603 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36604 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36605 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36606 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36607 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36608 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36609 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36610 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36611 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36613 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36614 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36615 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36617 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
36618 .cindex millisecond logging
36619 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
36620 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
36621 appended to the seconds value.
36623 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36624 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36625 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36626 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36627 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36628 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36629 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36630 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36631 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36633 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36634 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
36635 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36636 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36637 containing => tags) following the IP address.
36638 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36639 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36640 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36641 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36642 local port is a random ephemeral port.
36644 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36645 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36646 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36647 immediately after the time and date.
36649 .cindex "log" "queue run"
36650 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
36651 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
36653 .cindex "log" "queue time"
36654 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
36655 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
36656 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
36657 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
36658 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
36659 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
36660 message has been successfully received.
36661 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36662 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
36664 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
36665 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
36666 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
36667 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
36670 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
36671 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
36672 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
36673 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36674 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
36677 .cindex "log" "recipients"
36678 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
36679 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
36680 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
36681 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
36683 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
36686 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
36687 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
36688 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
36689 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
36691 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
36692 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36693 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36694 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36695 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36697 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
36698 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36699 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36700 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36703 .cindex "log" "return path"
36704 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36705 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36706 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36707 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36709 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36710 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36711 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36712 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36713 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36715 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36716 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36717 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36718 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36721 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
36722 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36725 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36726 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36727 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36728 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36730 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36731 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
36733 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
36734 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
36735 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
36736 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
36737 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
36738 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
36741 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36742 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36743 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36744 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36745 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36746 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36747 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36748 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36749 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36750 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36752 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36753 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36754 reset if the daemon is restarted.
36755 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36756 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36757 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36758 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36759 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36761 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36762 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36763 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36764 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36765 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36766 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36768 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36769 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36770 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36771 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36772 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36773 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36774 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36775 already have their own log lines.
36777 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36778 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36779 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36780 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36781 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36782 the same logging options.
36784 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36785 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36789 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36790 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36791 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36792 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36793 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36795 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36796 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36797 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36798 was accepted or used.
36800 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36801 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36802 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36803 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36804 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36805 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36806 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36807 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36809 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36810 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36811 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36812 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36813 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36814 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36815 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36816 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36817 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36819 .cindex "log" "subject"
36820 .cindex "subject, logging"
36821 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36822 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36823 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36824 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36825 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36827 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36829 .cindex DANE logging
36830 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36831 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36834 using a CA trust anchor,
36835 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
36837 and &`CV=no`& if not.
36839 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36840 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36841 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36842 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36844 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36845 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36846 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36847 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36848 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36850 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36851 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36852 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36853 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36854 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36856 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36857 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36858 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36862 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
36863 .cindex "message" "log file for"
36864 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36865 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36866 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36867 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36868 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36869 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36870 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36871 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36872 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36873 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36874 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36876 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36877 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36878 &%message_logs%& option false.
36884 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36885 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36887 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36888 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36889 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36890 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36891 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36893 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36894 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36895 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36896 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36897 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36898 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36899 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36901 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36902 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36903 "extract statistics from the log"
36904 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36905 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36906 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36907 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36908 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36909 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36910 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36911 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36914 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36915 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36916 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36921 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36922 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36923 .cindex "process, querying"
36925 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36926 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36927 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36928 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36929 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36930 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
36931 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
36932 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
36934 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
36935 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
36936 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
36939 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
36940 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
36941 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
36942 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
36943 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
36946 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
36947 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
36948 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
36949 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
36951 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
36953 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
36954 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
36955 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
36956 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
36957 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
36958 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
36960 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
36961 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
36965 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
36966 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
36967 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
36968 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
36972 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
36976 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
36977 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
36979 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
36980 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
36983 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
36984 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36985 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
36989 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
36990 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36991 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
36993 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
36994 Match against the size field.
36996 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36997 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
36999 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37000 Match messages that are older than the given time.
37003 Match only frozen messages.
37006 Match only non-frozen messages.
37009 The following options control the format of the output:
37013 Display only the count of matching messages.
37016 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37020 Display message ids only.
37023 Brief format &-- one line per message.
37026 Display messages in reverse order.
37029 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37032 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37036 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37037 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37038 .cindex "queue" "summary"
37039 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37040 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
37041 running a command such as
37043 exim -bp | exiqsumm
37045 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37046 it, as in the following example:
37048 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37050 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37051 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37052 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37053 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37055 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37056 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37057 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37058 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37059 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37060 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37063 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37064 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37065 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37066 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37067 level"& addresses).
37072 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37074 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37075 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37076 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37077 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37078 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37079 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37080 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37081 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37082 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37083 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37085 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37087 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37089 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37090 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37091 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
37093 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37094 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37095 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37096 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37097 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37099 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37100 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37101 regular expression.
37103 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37104 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37106 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37107 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37111 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37112 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37113 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37114 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37115 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37116 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37119 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37120 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37121 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37122 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37123 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37126 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37127 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
37128 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37129 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37130 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37131 the &%--help%& option.
37134 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37135 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37136 .cindex "cycling logs"
37137 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37138 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37139 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37140 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37141 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37142 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37143 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37145 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37146 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37148 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37149 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37150 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
37154 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
37155 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
37156 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
37157 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
37158 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
37159 logs are handled similarly.
37161 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
37162 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
37163 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
37164 any existing log files.
37166 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
37167 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
37168 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
37169 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
37170 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
37172 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
37174 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
37175 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
37179 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
37180 .cindex "statistics"
37181 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
37182 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
37183 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
37184 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
37185 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
37187 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
37188 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
37189 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
37190 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
37191 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
37193 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
37195 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
37196 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
37197 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
37198 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
37199 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
37200 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
37201 also produced per user.
37203 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
37204 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
37205 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
37206 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
37207 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
37209 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37210 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37211 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37212 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37213 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37214 an entirely separate message.
37216 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37217 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37218 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37219 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37220 least one address that failed.
37222 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37223 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37224 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37225 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
37226 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37227 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37228 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37230 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37231 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37232 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37234 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37235 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37236 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37238 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37241 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37242 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37243 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37244 .cindex "checking access"
37245 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37246 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37247 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37248 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37249 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37250 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37252 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37253 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37255 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37257 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37258 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37259 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37260 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37263 550 Relay not permitted
37265 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37266 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37267 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37268 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37271 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37272 -f himself@there.example
37274 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37275 mandatory arguments.
37277 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37278 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37279 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37283 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
37284 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
37285 .cindex "building DBM files"
37286 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
37287 .cindex "lower casing"
37288 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
37289 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
37290 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
37291 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
37292 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
37293 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
37295 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
37296 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
37297 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
37298 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
37301 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
37302 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
37303 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
37307 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
37308 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
37309 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
37310 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
37312 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
37314 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
37315 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
37317 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
37318 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
37319 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
37320 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
37321 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
37322 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
37324 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
37325 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
37326 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
37327 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
37328 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
37329 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
37330 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
37336 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
37337 .cindex "retry" "times"
37338 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
37339 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
37340 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
37341 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
37342 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
37343 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
37344 output. For example:
37346 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
37347 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
37348 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37349 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37350 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
37351 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
37352 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
37353 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
37354 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
37355 past final cutoff time
37357 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
37358 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
37359 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
37360 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
37361 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
37362 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
37365 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
37366 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
37367 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
37368 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
37369 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
37370 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
37374 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
37375 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
37376 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
37377 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
37378 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
37379 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
37380 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
37383 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
37385 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
37388 &'callout'&: the callout cache
37390 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
37392 &'misc'&: other hints data
37395 The &'misc'& database is used for
37398 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
37400 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
37401 &(smtp)& transport)
37403 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
37409 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
37410 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
37411 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
37412 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
37413 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
37415 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
37417 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
37419 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
37420 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
37422 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
37423 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
37424 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
37425 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
37426 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
37427 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
37428 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
37429 and a textual description of the error.
37431 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
37432 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
37433 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
37436 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
37437 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
37438 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
37439 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
37440 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
37441 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
37446 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
37447 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
37448 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
37449 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
37450 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
37451 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
37452 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
37453 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
37454 updated sufficiently often.
37456 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
37457 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
37458 the retry database:
37460 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37462 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37463 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37464 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37465 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37466 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37467 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37468 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37469 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37470 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37471 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37472 whenever it removes information from the database.
37474 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37475 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37476 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37477 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37478 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37480 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37481 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37482 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37483 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37484 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37485 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37486 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37489 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37490 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37495 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37496 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37497 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37498 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37499 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37500 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37501 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37504 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37505 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37506 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37507 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37508 by new data, for example:
37512 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37513 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37514 used as optional separators.
37519 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37520 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37521 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37522 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
37523 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37524 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37525 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37526 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37527 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37528 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37529 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37530 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37531 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37535 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37538 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37541 .vitem &%-interval%&
37542 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37543 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37545 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
37546 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37549 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37552 Suppress verification output.
37554 .vitem &%-retries%&
37555 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37556 the lock (default 10).
37558 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
37559 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37560 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37561 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37564 .vitem &%-timeout%&
37565 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37566 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37567 default), a non-blocking call is used.
37570 Generate verbose output.
37573 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37574 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37575 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37576 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37577 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37578 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37579 more than 30 minutes old.
37581 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37582 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37583 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37584 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37585 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37586 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37588 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37589 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37590 suppresses all output except error messages.
37594 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37596 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37598 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37599 <&'some commands'&>
37602 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37603 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37606 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37607 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37609 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37610 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37614 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37617 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37618 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37619 .cindex "X-windows"
37620 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
37621 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37622 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37623 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37624 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37625 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37626 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37627 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37631 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37632 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37633 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37634 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37635 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37636 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37637 parameters are for.
37639 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37640 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37641 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37643 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37645 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37646 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37647 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
37648 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
37649 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
37651 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
37652 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
37654 Eximon*background: gray94
37656 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
37657 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
37658 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
37659 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
37660 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
37661 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
37662 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
37665 Eximon*highlight: gray
37668 .cindex "admin user"
37669 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
37670 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
37672 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
37673 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
37674 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
37675 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
37676 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
37678 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
37679 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
37680 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
37681 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
37682 different parts of the display.
37687 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
37688 .cindex "stripchart"
37689 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
37690 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37691 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
37692 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
37693 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
37694 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
37695 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
37696 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
37697 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37699 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37700 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37701 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37702 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37704 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37705 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37706 to a single partition.
37708 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37709 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37710 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37711 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37712 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37713 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37714 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37719 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37720 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37721 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37722 .cindex "window size"
37723 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37724 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37725 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37726 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37727 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37728 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37730 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37731 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37732 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37733 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
37735 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
37736 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
37737 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
37738 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
37739 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
37740 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37742 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
37743 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
37744 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37748 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
37749 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37750 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37751 the main log is maintained.
37752 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37753 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37754 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37755 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37756 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37758 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37759 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37760 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37761 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37762 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37763 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37764 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37765 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37766 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37767 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37768 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37770 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37771 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37772 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37773 It cannot go further back up the log.
37775 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37776 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37777 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37778 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37779 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37780 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37782 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37783 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37784 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37785 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37786 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37787 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37789 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37790 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37791 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37792 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37793 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37794 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37795 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37796 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37797 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37802 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37803 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37804 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37805 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37806 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37807 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37808 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37809 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37810 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37811 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37813 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37814 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37815 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37816 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37817 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37818 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37819 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37821 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37822 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37823 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37824 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37825 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37826 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37827 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37829 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37830 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37831 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37832 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37834 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37835 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37836 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37837 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37838 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37839 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37840 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37843 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37844 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37846 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37847 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37848 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37849 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37850 display is updated.
37854 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37855 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37856 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37857 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37858 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37861 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37862 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37863 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37864 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37865 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37867 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37869 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37873 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37874 in a new text window.
37876 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37877 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37878 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37880 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37881 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37882 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37883 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37885 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37886 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37887 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37888 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37889 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37891 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37892 that the message be frozen.
37894 .cindex "thawing messages"
37895 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
37896 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37897 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37898 that the message be thawed.
37900 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37901 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37902 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37903 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37905 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37906 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37909 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37910 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37911 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37912 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37913 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37914 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37915 which case no action is taken.
37917 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37918 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37919 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37920 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37921 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37922 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37923 case no action is taken.
37925 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37926 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37928 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37929 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37930 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
37931 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
37932 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
37933 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
37934 the address is qualified with that domain.
37937 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
37938 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
37939 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
37940 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
37941 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
37942 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
37943 if no output is generated.
37945 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
37946 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
37947 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
37948 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
37950 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
37951 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
37952 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
37959 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37960 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37962 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
37963 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
37964 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
37965 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
37967 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
37968 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
37969 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
37970 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
37971 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
37972 its security as compared with other MTAs.
37974 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
37975 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
37976 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
37977 as soon as possible.
37980 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
37981 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
37982 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
37983 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
37984 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
37985 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
37988 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
37989 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
37990 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
37991 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
37992 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
37993 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
37995 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
37996 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
37997 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
37998 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38001 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38002 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38003 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38004 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38005 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38006 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38007 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38008 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38009 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38013 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38014 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38015 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38016 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38017 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38018 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38019 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38021 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38024 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38025 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38026 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38027 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38028 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38033 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38035 .cindex "root privilege"
38036 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38037 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38038 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38039 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38040 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38041 is required for two things:
38044 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38045 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38048 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38049 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38053 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38054 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38055 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38056 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38057 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38058 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
38059 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38060 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38062 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38063 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38064 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38066 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38067 uid and gid in the following cases:
38072 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38073 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38074 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38075 the calling process.
38076 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38077 option may not be used at all.
38078 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38079 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38080 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38085 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38086 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38089 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38090 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38091 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38092 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38093 testing address verification
38096 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38099 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38100 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38103 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38106 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38107 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38108 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38109 will be used during message reception.
38111 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38112 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38114 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38115 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38116 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38117 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38118 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38119 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38120 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38121 generating bounce and warning messages.
38123 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38124 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38125 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38126 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38128 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38129 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38135 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38136 .cindex "privilege, running without"
38137 .cindex "unprivileged running"
38138 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38139 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38140 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38141 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38142 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38143 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38144 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38148 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38149 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38150 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38151 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
38153 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
38154 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
38155 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
38156 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
38157 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
38159 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
38160 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
38161 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
38164 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
38165 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
38166 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
38168 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
38169 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
38170 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
38171 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
38172 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
38173 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
38174 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
38175 address this problem at this time.
38177 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
38178 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
38179 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
38180 be used in the most straightforward way.
38182 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
38183 number of restrictions on what you can do:
38186 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
38187 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
38188 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
38189 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
38190 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
38192 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
38193 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
38195 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
38196 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
38197 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
38198 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
38200 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
38201 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
38204 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
38205 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
38206 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
38208 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
38209 owned by the Exim user.
38211 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38212 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38213 mailboxes need to be created manually.
38218 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38219 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38220 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38221 gives more security at essentially no cost.
38223 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38224 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38229 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38230 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38231 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38235 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38236 .cindex "security" "local commands"
38237 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38238 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38239 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38240 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38241 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38244 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38245 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38246 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38247 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38248 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38250 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38251 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38252 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38253 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38254 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38255 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38256 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38258 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38259 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38260 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38262 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38263 taint checking might apply to their usage.
38265 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38266 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38267 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38269 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38270 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38271 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38273 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38274 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38275 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38276 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38282 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38283 .cindex "security" "data sources"
38284 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
38285 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
38286 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
38287 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
38288 are some issues to be aware of:
38291 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
38293 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
38295 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
38296 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
38297 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
38298 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
38299 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
38300 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
38303 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
38304 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
38305 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
38307 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
38308 expected to yield one result.
38314 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
38315 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
38316 .cindex "IP source routing"
38317 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
38318 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
38319 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
38320 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
38324 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
38325 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
38326 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
38331 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
38332 .cindex "trusted users"
38333 .cindex "admin user"
38334 .cindex "privileged user"
38335 .cindex "user" "trusted"
38336 .cindex "user" "admin"
38337 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
38338 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
38339 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
38340 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
38341 permit a remote host to be specified.
38344 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
38345 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
38346 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
38347 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
38348 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
38349 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
38351 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
38352 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
38353 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
38354 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
38355 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
38357 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
38358 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
38359 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
38360 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
38361 includes the contents of files on the spool.
38365 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
38366 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
38367 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
38368 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
38369 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
38370 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
38372 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
38373 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
38374 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
38375 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
38376 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
38377 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
38380 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
38381 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
38382 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
38383 This affects most of the checking options,
38384 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
38387 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
38388 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
38389 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
38390 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
38391 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
38392 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
38396 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
38397 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
38398 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
38399 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
38400 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
38405 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
38406 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
38407 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
38408 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
38413 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
38414 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
38415 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
38416 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
38417 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
38421 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
38422 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
38423 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
38427 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
38428 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
38429 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
38430 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
38431 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
38432 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
38433 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
38435 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
38436 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
38441 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
38442 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
38443 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
38444 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
38448 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
38449 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
38450 enough to hold the result.
38451 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
38456 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38457 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38459 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
38460 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
38461 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
38462 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
38463 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
38464 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38465 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38466 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38467 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38468 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38469 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38470 themselves are recoverable.
38472 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38473 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38474 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38477 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38478 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38479 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38480 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38481 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38483 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38484 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38485 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38486 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38488 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38490 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38493 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38495 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38496 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38497 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38498 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38499 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38500 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38501 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38502 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38505 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
38506 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
38507 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
38508 relics of crashes and can be removed.
38510 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38511 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38512 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38513 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38514 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38515 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38516 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38517 normally the Exim user.
38519 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38520 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38521 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38522 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38523 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38524 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38525 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38526 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38528 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38529 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38530 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38531 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38533 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38534 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38537 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38538 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38539 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38540 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38541 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38542 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38543 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38544 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38545 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38548 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38549 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38550 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38551 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38552 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38553 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38555 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38556 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38557 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38558 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38559 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38560 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38562 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38563 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38564 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38566 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38567 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38568 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38569 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38570 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38572 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38573 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38574 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38575 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38576 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38578 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38579 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38580 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38582 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38583 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38584 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38586 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38587 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38588 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38590 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38591 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38592 present if the number is greater than zero.
38594 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38595 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38596 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38598 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38599 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38600 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38602 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38603 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38606 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38607 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38608 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38611 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38612 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38613 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38614 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38616 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38617 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38618 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38620 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38621 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38622 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38623 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38624 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38625 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38627 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38628 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38629 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38630 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38631 supplied by the remote host, if any.
38633 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38634 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38635 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38636 generated messages.
38639 The message is from a local sender.
38641 .vitem &%-localerror%&
38642 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
38644 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
38645 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
38646 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
38647 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
38649 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
38650 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
38651 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
38654 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
38655 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
38658 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
38659 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
38660 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
38662 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
38663 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
38664 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
38666 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
38667 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
38668 of &$spam_score_int$&.
38670 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
38671 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
38672 rather than Unix-format.
38673 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
38674 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
38676 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
38677 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
38678 certificate was verified by the server.
38680 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
38681 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
38682 name of the cipher suite that was used.
38684 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
38685 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
38686 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
38690 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
38691 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
38692 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
38693 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
38694 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
38695 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
38696 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
38697 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
38698 addresses are complete.
38700 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
38701 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
38702 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
38703 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
38704 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
38705 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
38707 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
38708 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
38709 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38711 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
38712 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
38713 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38714 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38718 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38719 darcy@austen.fict.example
38721 alice@wonderland.fict.example
38723 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38724 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38725 line is of the following form:
38727 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
38728 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
38730 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
38731 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
38732 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
38733 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
38734 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
38735 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
38736 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
38737 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
38740 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
38741 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
38742 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
38743 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
38744 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
38748 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
38749 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
38750 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
38751 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
38752 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
38753 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
38754 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
38755 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
38756 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
38757 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
38760 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
38761 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38762 typical set of headers:
38764 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38765 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38766 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38767 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38768 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38769 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38770 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38771 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38772 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38773 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38774 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38776 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38777 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38778 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38779 .ecindex IIDforspo1
38780 .ecindex IIDforspo2
38781 .ecindex IIDforspo3
38783 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
38784 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
38785 an ASCII newline character.
38786 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
38787 can have an alternate format.
38788 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
38789 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
38790 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
38791 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
38792 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
38793 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
38795 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38796 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38798 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38799 "DKIM and SPF Support"
38802 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
38804 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38805 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38806 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38807 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
38810 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
38811 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
38812 any original DKIM signature.
38815 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38816 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38818 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
38820 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38821 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38822 (including transport filters)
38823 except cutthrough delivery.
38825 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38826 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38827 different signature contexts.
38830 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38831 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38832 Exim's standard controls.
38835 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38836 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
38838 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
38839 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
38840 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38841 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38843 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38844 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38845 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38846 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38850 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38851 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38852 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38853 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38857 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38858 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38861 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
38862 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38864 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38866 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38867 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38870 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
38871 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
38872 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
38873 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
38874 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
38877 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38878 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38880 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
38881 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
38882 After expansion, this can be a list.
38883 Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
38884 while expanding the remaining signing options.
38885 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
38886 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38888 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
38889 This sets the key selector string.
38890 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
38891 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
38892 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38893 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38894 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
38895 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38897 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38898 This sets the private key to use.
38899 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38900 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38901 The result can either
38903 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
38906 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or later, be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
38909 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38912 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38913 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38918 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38920 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38921 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38924 Support for EC keys is being developed under
38925 &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-dcrup-dkim-crypto/).
38926 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
38927 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
38928 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
38929 for some transition period.
38930 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
38934 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
38935 Can be set alternatively to &"sha1"& to use an alternate hash
38939 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38941 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38945 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
38946 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
38947 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
38948 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
38949 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
38950 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
38952 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
38953 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
38954 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
38955 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
38956 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
38958 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
38959 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
38960 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
38961 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
38962 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
38965 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
38966 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
38967 list of header names.
38968 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
38969 in the message signature.
38970 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
38971 whether or not each header is present in the message.
38972 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
38973 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
38975 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
38976 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
38977 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
38979 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
38980 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
38982 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
38983 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
38984 name will be appended.
38987 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
38988 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
38990 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is implemented via the
38991 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
38992 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
38993 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
38994 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
38995 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
38996 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
38998 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
38999 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39000 runtime of the ACL.
39002 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39003 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39004 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39005 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39007 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39008 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39009 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39010 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39011 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39012 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39015 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39017 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39018 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39019 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39021 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39023 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39024 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39025 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39027 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39030 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39031 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39033 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39034 for each matching signature.
39037 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39038 available (from most to least important):
39042 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39043 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39044 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39045 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39047 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39048 Within the DKIM ACL,
39049 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39051 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39052 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39054 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39055 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39057 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39058 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39060 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39063 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39064 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39065 hash-method or key-size:
39067 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39068 condition = ${if eq {$len_3:$dkim_algo}{rsa}}
39069 condition = ${if or {eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39070 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}} }
39071 logwrite = NOTE: forcing dkim verify fail (was pass)
39072 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39073 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39076 After all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39077 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39079 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39080 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39081 "fail" or "invalid". One of
39083 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39084 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
39086 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
39087 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
39089 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
39090 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
39091 means that the message body was modified in transit.
39093 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
39094 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
39095 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
39096 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
39099 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39101 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
39102 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
39103 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
39104 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39106 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
39107 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
39108 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
39109 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39111 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
39112 The key record selector string.
39114 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
39115 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
39117 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or later, may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
39118 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39123 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39125 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39127 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
39128 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
39131 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39132 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39135 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
39136 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39138 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
39139 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39141 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
39142 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
39143 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
39144 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
39145 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
39146 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
39148 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
39149 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
39150 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
39151 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
39153 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
39154 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
39155 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
39157 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
39158 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
39159 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
39160 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
39161 integer size comparisons against this value.
39163 Note that Exim does not check this value.
39166 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
39167 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
39169 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
39170 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
39172 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
39173 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
39175 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
39176 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39179 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
39180 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39183 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
39184 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
39186 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
39187 Number of bits in the key.
39190 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39192 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
39193 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
39196 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39197 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39198 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
39203 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
39206 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
39207 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
39208 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
39209 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
39210 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
39213 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
39214 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
39215 sender_domains = gmail.com
39216 dkim_signers = gmail.com
39220 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
39221 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
39223 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
39224 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
39225 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
39226 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
39229 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
39230 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
39231 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
39232 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
39235 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
39236 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
39237 for more information of what they mean.
39244 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
39245 .cindex SPF verification
39247 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
39248 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
39249 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
39251 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
39252 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
39254 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
39255 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
39256 &url(http://www.libspf2.org/).
39257 There is no Exim involvement on the trasmission of messages; publishing certain
39258 DNS records is all that is required.
39260 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
39262 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39263 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
39264 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
39265 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
39266 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
39270 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
39273 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
39274 domain in the envelope-from address.
39276 .vitem &%softfail%&
39277 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
39281 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
39284 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
39285 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
39286 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
39288 .vitem &%permerror%&
39289 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
39290 You may deny messages when this occurs. (Changed in 4.83)
39292 .vitem &%temperror%&
39293 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
39294 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
39297 .vitem &%err_temp%&
39298 Same as permerror, deprecated in 4.83, will be removed in a future release.
39300 .vitem &%err_perm%&
39301 Same as temperror, deprecated in 4.83, will be removed in a future release.
39304 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
39305 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
39306 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
39307 short-circuit fashion.
39312 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
39313 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
39314 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
39315 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
39316 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
39317 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
39318 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
39319 ip=$sender_host_address
39322 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
39325 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
39327 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
39328 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
39329 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
39330 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
39331 it for logging purposes.
39333 .vitem &$spf_received$&
39334 .vindex &$spf_received$&
39335 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
39336 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
39337 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
39338 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
39340 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
39341 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
39343 .vitem &$spf_result$&
39344 .vindex &$spf_result$&
39345 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
39346 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
39349 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39350 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39351 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
39352 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
39356 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39357 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
39358 .cindex SPF "best guess"
39359 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
39360 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
39361 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
39363 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
39364 for a description of what it means.
39366 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
39367 of the spf one. For example:
39370 deny spf_guess = fail
39371 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
39374 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
39375 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
39376 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
39379 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
39380 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
39382 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
39383 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
39384 &%spf_guess%& option.
39385 For example, the following:
39388 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
39391 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
39394 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
39396 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
39397 address as the key and an IP address as the database:
39400 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
39403 The lookup will return the same result strings as they can appear in
39404 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
39405 Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
39408 . wen-for SPF section
39412 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39413 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39415 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
39417 .cindex "proxy support"
39418 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
39420 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
39421 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
39424 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
39425 .cindex proxy inbound
39426 .cindex proxy "server side"
39427 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
39428 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
39430 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
39431 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
39432 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
39435 It was built on specifications from:
39436 (&url(http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt)).
39437 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
39438 (&url(http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e)).
39440 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
39441 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
39442 to distribute load.
39443 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
39444 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
39445 There is no logging if a host passes or
39446 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
39447 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
39449 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
39450 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
39451 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
39452 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
39453 automatically determines which version is in use.
39455 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
39456 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
39457 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
39458 Exim and the proxy server.
39460 The following expansion variables are usable
39461 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
39464 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
39465 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
39466 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
39467 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
39468 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
39470 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
39471 there was a protocol error.
39473 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
39474 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
39475 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
39476 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
39477 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
39478 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
39479 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
39480 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
39481 A possible solution is:
39483 # Set max number of connections per host
39485 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
39486 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
39488 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
39489 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
39494 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
39495 .cindex proxy outbound
39496 .cindex proxy "client side"
39497 .cindex proxy SOCKS
39498 .cindex SOCKS proxy
39499 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
39500 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
39501 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
39504 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
39505 on an smtp transport.
39506 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
39507 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
39508 Each proxy specifier is a list
39509 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
39510 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
39512 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
39513 The list of options is in the following table:
39515 &'auth '& authentication method
39516 &'name '& authentication username
39517 &'pass '& authentication password
39519 &'tmo '& connection timeout
39521 &'weight '& selection bias
39524 More details on each of these options follows:
39527 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
39528 .cindex proxy authentication
39529 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
39530 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
39531 for access to the proxy.
39532 Default is &"none"&.
39534 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
39537 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
39540 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
39543 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
39546 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
39547 higher values being tried first.
39548 The default priority is 1.
39550 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
39551 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
39552 weighted by this value.
39553 The default value for selection bias is 1.
39556 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
39557 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
39558 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
39560 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
39561 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
39562 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
39563 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
39565 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39566 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39568 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
39569 "Internationalisation""
39570 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
39573 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
39575 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
39576 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
39577 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
39579 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
39580 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
39581 requirement, upon libidn2.
39583 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
39584 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
39585 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
39586 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
39587 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
39588 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
39590 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
39591 international handling for the message is enabled and
39592 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
39594 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
39595 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
39596 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
39597 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
39599 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
39600 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
39601 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
39602 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
39604 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
39605 components expanded to a-label form,
39606 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
39609 .cindex log protocol
39610 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
39611 .cindex i18n logging
39612 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
39613 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
39615 The following expansion operators can be used:
39617 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
39618 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
39619 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
39620 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
39623 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
39624 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
39628 may use the following modifier:
39630 control = utf8_downconvert
39631 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
39633 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
39634 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
39635 Message Submission Agent context.
39636 If a value is appended it may be:
39638 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
39639 &`0 `& no downconversion
39640 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
39643 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
39644 is initially set to -1.
39647 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
39648 Configurations supporting these should inspect
39649 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
39651 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
39652 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
39653 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
39655 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
39656 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
39660 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
39661 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
39662 the following expansion operator can be used:
39664 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
39667 The string is converted from the charset specified by
39668 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
39669 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
39671 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
39672 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
39673 (which has to be a single character)
39674 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
39675 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
39677 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
39678 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
39680 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
39681 by many other IMAP servers.
39685 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
39686 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
39687 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
39690 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
39691 must be representable in UTF-16.
39694 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39695 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39697 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
39701 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
39702 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
39703 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
39704 processing actions.
39706 Most installations will never need to use Events.
39707 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
39708 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39710 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
39711 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
39712 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
39714 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
39715 An example might look like:
39716 .cindex logging custom
39718 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
39719 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
39720 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
39721 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
39722 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
39723 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
39724 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
39725 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
39726 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
39730 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
39731 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
39732 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
39734 The current list of events is:
39736 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
39737 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
39738 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39739 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
39740 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
39741 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
39742 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39743 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
39744 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
39745 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
39746 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
39747 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
39749 New event types may be added in future.
39751 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
39752 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
39753 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
39755 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
39756 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
39757 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
39759 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
39760 should define the event action.
39762 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
39763 with the event type:
39765 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
39766 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
39767 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
39768 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
39769 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
39770 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
39771 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
39774 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
39776 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
39777 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
39778 the course of its processing:
39780 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
39783 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
39784 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
39786 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
39787 a useful way of writing to the main log.
39789 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
39790 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
39791 following will be forced:
39793 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
39794 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
39795 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
39797 All other message types ignore the result string, and
39798 no other use is made of it.
39800 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
39801 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
39804 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
39805 chain element received on the connection.
39806 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
39809 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39810 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39812 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
39813 "Adding drivers or lookups"
39814 .cindex "adding drivers"
39815 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
39816 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
39817 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
39818 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
39821 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
39822 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
39824 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
39826 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
39828 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
39829 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
39830 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
39832 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
39834 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
39837 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
39838 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
39840 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
39841 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
39842 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
39843 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
39844 simple form that most lookups have.
39846 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
39847 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
39848 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
39850 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
39853 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
39854 as for other drivers and lookups.
39857 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
39858 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
39859 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
39860 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
39861 searched using a binary chop procedure.
39863 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
39864 the interface that is expected.
39869 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39870 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39872 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39873 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
39874 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
39875 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
39877 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39882 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
39883 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
39887 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
39888 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
39889 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
39892 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39893 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////